Prevent illegal memory accesses when parsing incorrecctly formated core notes.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf.c
1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /*
24 SECTION
25 ELF backends
26
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
34
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36 #define _SYSCALL32
37 #include "sysdep.h"
38 #include "bfd.h"
39 #include "bfdlink.h"
40 #include "libbfd.h"
41 #define ARCH_SIZE 0
42 #include "elf-bfd.h"
43 #include "libiberty.h"
44 #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
46
47 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
48 #include CORE_HEADER
49 #endif
50
51 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type) ;
56 static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
57 file_ptr offset);
58
59 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
60 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
61 need to move into elfcode.h. */
62
63 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
64
65 void
66 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
67 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
68 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
69 {
70 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
71 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
72 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
73 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
74 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
75 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
76 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
77 }
78
79 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
80
81 void
82 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
83 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
84 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
85 {
86 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
90 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
93 }
94
95 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
96
97 void
98 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
99 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
100 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
101 {
102 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
103 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
104 }
105
106 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
107
108 void
109 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
110 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
111 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
112 {
113 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
115 }
116
117 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
118
119 void
120 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
121 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
122 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
123 {
124 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
125 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
126 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
127 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
128 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
129 }
130
131 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
132
133 void
134 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
135 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
136 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
137 {
138 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
140 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
143 }
144
145 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
146
147 void
148 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
149 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
150 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
151 {
152 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
153 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
154 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
155 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
156 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
157 }
158
159 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
160
161 void
162 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
163 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
164 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
165 {
166 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
167 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
169 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
171 }
172
173 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
174
175 void
176 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
177 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
178 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
179 {
180 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
181 }
182
183 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
184
185 void
186 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
187 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
188 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
189 {
190 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
191 }
192
193 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
194 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
195
196 unsigned long
197 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
198 {
199 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
200 unsigned long h = 0;
201 unsigned long g;
202 int ch;
203
204 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
205 {
206 h = (h << 4) + ch;
207 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
208 {
209 h ^= g >> 24;
210 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
211 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
212 h ^= g;
213 }
214 }
215 return h & 0xffffffff;
216 }
217
218 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
219 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
220
221 unsigned long
222 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
223 {
224 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
225 unsigned long h = 5381;
226 unsigned char ch;
227
228 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
229 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
230 return h & 0xffffffff;
231 }
232
233 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
234 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
235 bfd_boolean
236 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
237 size_t object_size,
238 enum elf_target_id object_id)
239 {
240 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
241 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
242 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
243 return FALSE;
244
245 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
246 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
247 {
248 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
249 if (o == NULL)
250 return FALSE;
251 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
252 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
253 }
254 return TRUE;
255 }
256
257
258 bfd_boolean
259 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
260 {
261 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
262 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
263 bed->target_id);
264 }
265
266 bfd_boolean
267 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
268 {
269 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
270 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
271 return FALSE;
272 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
273 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
274 }
275
276 static char *
277 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
278 {
279 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
280 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
281 file_ptr offset;
282 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
283
284 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
285 if (i_shdrp == 0
286 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
287 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
288 return NULL;
289
290 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
291 if (shstrtab == NULL)
292 {
293 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
294 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
295 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
296
297 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
298 in case the string table is not terminated. */
299 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
300 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
301 || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
302 shstrtab = NULL;
303 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
304 {
305 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
306 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
307 bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
308 shstrtab = NULL;
309 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
310 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
311 the string table over and over. */
312 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
313 }
314 else
315 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
316 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
317 }
318 return (char *) shstrtab;
319 }
320
321 char *
322 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
323 unsigned int shindex,
324 unsigned int strindex)
325 {
326 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
327
328 if (strindex == 0)
329 return "";
330
331 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
332 return NULL;
333
334 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
335
336 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
337 {
338 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
339 {
340 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
341 /* xgettext:c-format */
342 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: attempt to load strings from"
343 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
344 abfd, shindex);
345 return NULL;
346 }
347
348 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
349 return NULL;
350 }
351
352 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
353 {
354 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
355 _bfd_error_handler
356 /* xgettext:c-format */
357 (_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %Lu for section `%s'"),
358 abfd, strindex, hdr->sh_size,
359 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
360 ? ".shstrtab"
361 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
362 return NULL;
363 }
364
365 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
366 }
367
368 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
369 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
370 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
371 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
372 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
373 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
374 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
375
376 Elf_Internal_Sym *
377 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
378 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
379 size_t symcount,
380 size_t symoffset,
381 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
382 void *extsym_buf,
383 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
384 {
385 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
386 void *alloc_ext;
387 const bfd_byte *esym;
388 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
389 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
390 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
391 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
392 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
393 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
394 size_t extsym_size;
395 bfd_size_type amt;
396 file_ptr pos;
397
398 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
399 abort ();
400
401 if (symcount == 0)
402 return intsym_buf;
403
404 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
405 shndx_hdr = NULL;
406 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
407 {
408 elf_section_list * entry;
409 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
410
411 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
412 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
413 {
414 /* PR 20063. */
415 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
416 continue;
417
418 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
419 {
420 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
421 break;
422 };
423 }
424
425 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
426 {
427 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
428 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
429 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
430 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
431 the index table will not be needed. */
432 }
433 }
434
435 /* Read the symbols. */
436 alloc_ext = NULL;
437 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
438 alloc_intsym = NULL;
439 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
440 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
441 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * extsym_size;
442 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
443 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
444 {
445 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
446 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
447 }
448 if (extsym_buf == NULL
449 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
450 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
451 {
452 intsym_buf = NULL;
453 goto out;
454 }
455
456 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
457 extshndx_buf = NULL;
458 else
459 {
460 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
461 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
462 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
463 {
464 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
465 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
466 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
467 }
468 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
469 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
470 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
471 {
472 intsym_buf = NULL;
473 goto out;
474 }
475 }
476
477 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
478 {
479 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
480 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
481 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
482 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
483 goto out;
484 }
485
486 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
487 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
488 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
489 shndx = extshndx_buf;
490 isym < isymend;
491 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
492 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
493 {
494 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
495 /* xgettext:c-format */
496 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B symbol number %lu references"
497 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
498 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
499 if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
500 free (alloc_intsym);
501 intsym_buf = NULL;
502 goto out;
503 }
504
505 out:
506 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
507 free (alloc_ext);
508 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
509 free (alloc_extshndx);
510
511 return intsym_buf;
512 }
513
514 /* Look up a symbol name. */
515 const char *
516 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
517 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
518 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
519 asection *sym_sec)
520 {
521 const char *name;
522 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
523 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
524
525 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
526 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
527 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
528 {
529 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
530 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
531 }
532
533 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
534 if (name == NULL)
535 name = "(null)";
536 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
537 name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
538
539 return name;
540 }
541
542 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
543 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
544 pointers. */
545
546 typedef union elf_internal_group {
547 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
548 unsigned int flags;
549 } Elf_Internal_Group;
550
551 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
552 signature just a string? */
553
554 static const char *
555 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
556 {
557 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
558 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
559 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
560 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
561
562 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
563 that it is a symbol table section. */
564 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
565 return NULL;
566 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
567 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
568 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
569 return NULL;
570
571 /* Go read the symbol. */
572 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
573 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
574 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
575 return NULL;
576
577 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
578 }
579
580 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
581
582 static bfd_boolean
583 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
584 {
585 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
586
587 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
588 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
589 if (num_group == 0)
590 {
591 unsigned int i, shnum;
592
593 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
594 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
595 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
596 num_group = 0;
597
598 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
599 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
600 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
601 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
602 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
603
604 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
605 {
606 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
607
608 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
609 num_group += 1;
610 }
611
612 if (num_group == 0)
613 {
614 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
615 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
616 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
617 }
618 else
619 {
620 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
621 so we can find them quickly. */
622 bfd_size_type amt;
623
624 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
625 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
626 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
627 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
628 return FALSE;
629 memset (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr, 0, num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
630 num_group = 0;
631
632 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
633 {
634 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
635
636 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
637 {
638 unsigned char *src;
639 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
640
641 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
642 attached to it. */
643 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
644 return FALSE;
645
646 /* Add to list of sections. */
647 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
648 num_group += 1;
649
650 /* Read the raw contents. */
651 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
652 amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
653 shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
654 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
655 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
656 if (shdr->contents == NULL)
657 {
658 _bfd_error_handler
659 /* xgettext:c-format */
660 (_("%B: corrupt size field in group section"
661 " header: %#Lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
662 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
663 -- num_group;
664 continue;
665 }
666
667 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
668
669 if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
670 || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
671 != shdr->sh_size))
672 {
673 _bfd_error_handler
674 /* xgettext:c-format */
675 (_("%B: invalid size field in group section"
676 " header: %#Lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
677 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
678 -- num_group;
679 /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even
680 partially corrupt, do not allow any of the
681 contents to be used. */
682 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
683 continue;
684 }
685
686 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
687 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
688 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
689 pointers. */
690 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
691 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
692
693 while (1)
694 {
695 unsigned int idx;
696
697 src -= 4;
698 --dest;
699 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
700 if (src == shdr->contents)
701 {
702 dest->flags = idx;
703 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
704 shdr->bfd_section->flags
705 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
706 break;
707 }
708 if (idx >= shnum)
709 {
710 _bfd_error_handler
711 (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd);
712 idx = 0;
713 }
714 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
715 }
716 }
717 }
718
719 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
720 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
721 {
722 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
723
724 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
725 if (num_group == 0)
726 {
727 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
728 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
729 _bfd_error_handler
730 (_("%B: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
731 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
732 }
733 }
734 }
735 }
736
737 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
738 {
739 unsigned int i;
740
741 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
742 {
743 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
744 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
745 bfd_size_type n_elt;
746
747 if (shdr == NULL)
748 continue;
749
750 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
751 if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
752 {
753 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
754 /* xgettext:c-format */
755 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: group section '%A' has no contents"),
756 abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
757 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
758 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
759 return FALSE;
760 }
761 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
762
763 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
764 section is a member. */
765 while (--n_elt != 0)
766 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
767 {
768 asection *s = NULL;
769
770 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
771 other members to see if any others are linked via
772 next_in_group. */
773 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
774 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
775 while (--n_elt != 0)
776 if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
777 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
778 break;
779 if (n_elt != 0)
780 {
781 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
782 insert current section in circular list. */
783 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
784 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
785 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
786 }
787 else
788 {
789 const char *gname;
790
791 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
792 if (gname == NULL)
793 return FALSE;
794 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
795
796 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
797 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
798 }
799
800 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
801 new member. */
802 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
803 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
804
805 i = num_group - 1;
806 break;
807 }
808 }
809 }
810
811 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
812 {
813 /* xgettext:c-format */
814 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: no group info for section '%A'"),
815 abfd, newsect);
816 return FALSE;
817 }
818 return TRUE;
819 }
820
821 bfd_boolean
822 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
823 {
824 unsigned int i;
825 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
826 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
827 asection *s;
828
829 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
830 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
831 {
832 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
833 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
834 {
835 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
836 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
837 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
838 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
839 if (elfsec == 0)
840 {
841 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
842 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
843 bed->link_order_error_handler
844 /* xgettext:c-format */
845 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
846 abfd, s);
847 }
848 else
849 {
850 asection *linksec = NULL;
851
852 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
853 {
854 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
855 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
856 }
857
858 /* PR 1991, 2008:
859 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
860 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
861 if (linksec == NULL)
862 {
863 _bfd_error_handler
864 /* xgettext:c-format */
865 (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
866 s->owner, elfsec, s);
867 result = FALSE;
868 }
869
870 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
871 }
872 }
873 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
874 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
875 {
876 _bfd_error_handler
877 /* xgettext:c-format */
878 (_("%B: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
879 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
880 result = FALSE;
881 }
882 }
883
884 /* Process section groups. */
885 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
886 return result;
887
888 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
889 {
890 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
891 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
892 unsigned int n_elt;
893
894 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
895 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
896 {
897 _bfd_error_handler
898 /* xgettext:c-format */
899 (_("%B: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
900 abfd, i);
901 result = FALSE;
902 continue;
903 }
904
905 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
906 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
907
908 while (--n_elt != 0)
909 {
910 ++ idx;
911
912 if (idx->shdr == NULL)
913 continue;
914 else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
915 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
916 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
917 && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
918 {
919 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
920 _bfd_error_handler
921 /* xgettext:c-format */
922 (_("%B: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%A]"),
923 abfd,
924 idx->shdr->sh_type,
925 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
926 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
927 ->e_shstrndx),
928 idx->shdr->sh_name),
929 shdr->bfd_section);
930 result = FALSE;
931 }
932 }
933 }
934
935 return result;
936 }
937
938 bfd_boolean
939 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
940 {
941 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
942 }
943
944 static char *
945 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
946 {
947 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
948 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
949 if (new_name == NULL)
950 return NULL;
951 new_name[0] = '.';
952 new_name[1] = 'z';
953 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
954 return new_name;
955 }
956
957 static char *
958 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
959 {
960 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
961 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
962 if (new_name == NULL)
963 return NULL;
964 new_name[0] = '.';
965 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
966 return new_name;
967 }
968
969 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
970 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
971
972 bfd_boolean
973 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
974 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
975 const char *name,
976 int shindex)
977 {
978 asection *newsect;
979 flagword flags;
980 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
981
982 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
983 return TRUE;
984
985 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
986 if (newsect == NULL)
987 return FALSE;
988
989 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
990 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
991 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
992
993 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
994 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
995 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
996
997 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
998
999 if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
1000 || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1001 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
1002 bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1003 return FALSE;
1004
1005 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1006 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1007 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1008 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1009 flags |= SEC_GROUP;
1010 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1011 {
1012 flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
1013 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1014 flags |= SEC_LOAD;
1015 }
1016 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1017 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1018 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1019 flags |= SEC_CODE;
1020 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1021 flags |= SEC_DATA;
1022 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1023 {
1024 flags |= SEC_MERGE;
1025 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1026 }
1027 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1028 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1029 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1030 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1031 return FALSE;
1032 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1033 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1034 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1035 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1036
1037 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1038 {
1039 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1040 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1041 if (name [0] == '.')
1042 {
1043 const char *p;
1044 int n;
1045 if (name[1] == 'd')
1046 p = ".debug", n = 6;
1047 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
1048 p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
1049 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
1050 p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
1051 else if (name[1] == 'l')
1052 p = ".line", n = 5;
1053 else if (name[1] == 's')
1054 p = ".stab", n = 5;
1055 else if (name[1] == 'z')
1056 p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
1057 else
1058 p = NULL, n = 0;
1059 if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
1060 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1061 }
1062 }
1063
1064 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1065 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1066 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1067 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1068 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1069 all but one of the sections. */
1070 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1071 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1072 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1073
1074 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1075 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1076 if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
1077 return FALSE;
1078
1079 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
1080 return FALSE;
1081
1082 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1083 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1084 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1085 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1086 {
1087 bfd_byte *contents;
1088
1089 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1090 return FALSE;
1091
1092 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size, hdr->sh_offset);
1093 free (contents);
1094 }
1095
1096 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1097 {
1098 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1099 unsigned int i, nload;
1100
1101 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1102 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1103 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1104 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1105 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1106 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1107 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1108 break;
1109 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1110 ++nload;
1111 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1112 return TRUE;
1113
1114 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1115 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1116 {
1117 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1118 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1119 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1120 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1121 {
1122 if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1123 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1124 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
1125 else
1126 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1127 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1128 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1129 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1130 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1131 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1132 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1133 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1134 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
1135
1136 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1137 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1138 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1139 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1140 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1141 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1142 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1143 break;
1144 }
1145 }
1146 }
1147
1148 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1149 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1150 if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1151 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1152 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1153 {
1154 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1155 int compression_header_size;
1156 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1157 bfd_boolean compressed
1158 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1159 &compression_header_size,
1160 &uncompressed_size);
1161
1162 if (compressed)
1163 {
1164 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1165 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1166 action = decompress;
1167 }
1168
1169 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1170 section. Check if we should compress. */
1171 if (action == nothing)
1172 {
1173 if (newsect->size != 0
1174 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1175 && compression_header_size >= 0
1176 && uncompressed_size > 0
1177 && (!compressed
1178 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1179 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1180 action = compress;
1181 else
1182 return TRUE;
1183 }
1184
1185 if (action == compress)
1186 {
1187 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1188 {
1189 _bfd_error_handler
1190 /* xgettext:c-format */
1191 (_("%B: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1192 abfd, name);
1193 return FALSE;
1194 }
1195 }
1196 else
1197 {
1198 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1199 {
1200 _bfd_error_handler
1201 /* xgettext:c-format */
1202 (_("%B: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1203 abfd, name);
1204 return FALSE;
1205 }
1206 }
1207
1208 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1209 {
1210 if (name[1] == 'z'
1211 && (action == decompress
1212 || (action == compress
1213 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1214 {
1215 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1216 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1217 section. */
1218 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1219 if (new_name == NULL)
1220 return FALSE;
1221 bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1222 }
1223 }
1224 else
1225 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1226 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1227 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1228 }
1229
1230 return TRUE;
1231 }
1232
1233 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1234 {
1235 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1236 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1237 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1238 };
1239
1240 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1241 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1242 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1243 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1244 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1245 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1246 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1247 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1248 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1249
1250 bfd_reloc_status_type
1251 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1252 arelent *reloc_entry,
1253 asymbol *symbol,
1254 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1255 asection *input_section,
1256 bfd *output_bfd,
1257 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1258 {
1259 if (output_bfd != NULL
1260 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1261 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1262 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1263 {
1264 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1265 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1266 }
1267
1268 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1269 }
1270 \f
1271 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1272 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1273 should be the same. */
1274
1275 static bfd_boolean
1276 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1277 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1278 {
1279 return
1280 a->sh_type == b->sh_type
1281 && (a->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1282 == (b->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1283 && a->sh_addralign == b->sh_addralign
1284 && a->sh_size == b->sh_size
1285 && a->sh_entsize == b->sh_entsize
1286 /* FIXME: Check sh_addr ? */
1287 ;
1288 }
1289
1290 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1291 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1292 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1293 to be the correct section. */
1294
1295 static unsigned int
1296 find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1297 const unsigned int hint)
1298 {
1299 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1300 unsigned int i;
1301
1302 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1303
1304 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1305 if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1306 && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1307 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1308 return hint;
1309
1310 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1311 {
1312 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1313
1314 if (oheader == NULL)
1315 continue;
1316 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1317 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1318 multiple matches ? */
1319 return i;
1320 }
1321
1322 return SHN_UNDEF;
1323 }
1324
1325 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1326 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1327 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1328
1329 static bfd_boolean
1330 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1331 bfd *obfd,
1332 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1333 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1334 const unsigned int secnum)
1335 {
1336 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1337 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1338 bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
1339 unsigned int sh_link;
1340
1341 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1342 {
1343 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1344 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1345 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1346 matched up with the original.
1347
1348 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1349 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1350 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1351 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1352 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1353 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1354 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1355 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1356 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1357 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1358 without any contents. */
1359 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1360 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1361 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1362 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1363 return TRUE;
1364 }
1365
1366 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1367 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL
1368 && bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
1369 (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader))
1370 return TRUE;
1371
1372 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1373 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1374 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1375 in the input bfd. */
1376 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1377 {
1378 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1379 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1380 {
1381 _bfd_error_handler
1382 /* xgettext:c-format */
1383 (_("%B: Invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1384 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1385 return FALSE;
1386 }
1387
1388 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1389 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1390 {
1391 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1392 changed = TRUE;
1393 }
1394 else
1395 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1396 if we could not find a match ? */
1397 _bfd_error_handler
1398 /* xgettext:c-format */
1399 (_("%B: Failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1400 }
1401
1402 if (iheader->sh_info)
1403 {
1404 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1405 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1406 section index. */
1407 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1408 {
1409 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1410 iheader->sh_info);
1411 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1412 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1413 }
1414 else
1415 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1416 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1417
1418 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1419 {
1420 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1421 changed = TRUE;
1422 }
1423 else
1424 _bfd_error_handler
1425 /* xgettext:c-format */
1426 (_("%B: Failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1427 }
1428
1429 return changed;
1430 }
1431
1432 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1433 another. */
1434
1435 bfd_boolean
1436 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1437 {
1438 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1439 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1440 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1441 unsigned int i;
1442
1443 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1444 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1445 return TRUE;
1446
1447 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1448 {
1449 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1450 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1451 }
1452
1453 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1454
1455 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1456 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1457 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1458
1459 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1460 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1461 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1462 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1463
1464 /* Copy object attributes. */
1465 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1466
1467 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1468 return TRUE;
1469
1470 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1471
1472 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1473 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1474 {
1475 unsigned int j;
1476 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1477
1478 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1479 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1480 files. See below for more details. */
1481 if (oheader == NULL
1482 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1483 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1484 continue;
1485
1486 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1487 fields have already been initialised. */
1488 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1489 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1490 continue;
1491
1492 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1493 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1494 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1495 {
1496 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1497
1498 if (iheader == NULL)
1499 continue;
1500
1501 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1502 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1503 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1504 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1505 {
1506 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1507 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1508 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1509 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1510 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1511 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1512 break;
1513 }
1514 }
1515
1516 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1517 continue;
1518
1519 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1520 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1521 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1522 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1523 {
1524 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1525
1526 if (iheader == NULL)
1527 continue;
1528
1529 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1530 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1531 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1532 input type. */
1533 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1534 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1535 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1536 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1537 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1538 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1539 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1540 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1541 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1542 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1543 {
1544 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1545 break;
1546 }
1547 }
1548
1549 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1550 {
1551 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1552 with a NULL input section. */
1553 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL)
1554 bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, NULL, oheader);
1555 }
1556 }
1557
1558 return TRUE;
1559 }
1560
1561 static const char *
1562 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1563 {
1564 const char *pt;
1565 switch (p_type)
1566 {
1567 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1568 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1569 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1570 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1571 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1572 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1573 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1574 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1575 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1576 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1577 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1578 default: pt = NULL; break;
1579 }
1580 return pt;
1581 }
1582
1583 /* Print out the program headers. */
1584
1585 bfd_boolean
1586 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1587 {
1588 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1589 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1590 asection *s;
1591 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1592
1593 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1594 if (p != NULL)
1595 {
1596 unsigned int i, c;
1597
1598 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1599 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1600 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1601 {
1602 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1603 char buf[20];
1604
1605 if (pt == NULL)
1606 {
1607 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1608 pt = buf;
1609 }
1610 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1611 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1612 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1613 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1614 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1615 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1616 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1617 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1618 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1619 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1620 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1621 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1622 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1623 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1624 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1625 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1626 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1627 fprintf (f, "\n");
1628 }
1629 }
1630
1631 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1632 if (s != NULL)
1633 {
1634 unsigned int elfsec;
1635 unsigned long shlink;
1636 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1637 size_t extdynsize;
1638 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1639
1640 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1641
1642 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1643 goto error_return;
1644
1645 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1646 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1647 goto error_return;
1648 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1649
1650 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1651 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1652
1653 extdyn = dynbuf;
1654 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1655 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1656 goto error_return;
1657 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1658 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1659 Fix range check. */
1660 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1661 {
1662 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1663 const char *name = "";
1664 char ab[20];
1665 bfd_boolean stringp;
1666 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1667
1668 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1669
1670 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1671 break;
1672
1673 stringp = FALSE;
1674 switch (dyn.d_tag)
1675 {
1676 default:
1677 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1678 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1679
1680 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1681 {
1682 sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1683 name = ab;
1684 }
1685 break;
1686
1687 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1688 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1689 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1690 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1691 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1692 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1693 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1694 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1695 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1696 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1697 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1698 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1699 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1700 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1701 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1702 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1703 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1704 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1705 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1706 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1707 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1708 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1709 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1710 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1711 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1712 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1713 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1714 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1715 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1716 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1717 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1718 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1719 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1720 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1721 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1722 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1723 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1724 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1725 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1726 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1727 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1728 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1729 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1730 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1731 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1732 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1733 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1734 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1735 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1736 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1737 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1738 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1739 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1740 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1741 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1742 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1743 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1744 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1745 }
1746
1747 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1748 if (! stringp)
1749 {
1750 fprintf (f, "0x");
1751 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1752 }
1753 else
1754 {
1755 const char *string;
1756 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1757
1758 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1759 if (string == NULL)
1760 goto error_return;
1761 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1762 }
1763 fprintf (f, "\n");
1764 }
1765
1766 free (dynbuf);
1767 dynbuf = NULL;
1768 }
1769
1770 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1771 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1772 {
1773 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1774 return FALSE;
1775 }
1776
1777 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1778 {
1779 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1780
1781 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1782 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1783 {
1784 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1785 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1786 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1787 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1788 {
1789 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1790
1791 fprintf (f, "\t");
1792 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1793 a != NULL;
1794 a = a->vda_nextptr)
1795 fprintf (f, "%s ",
1796 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1797 fprintf (f, "\n");
1798 }
1799 }
1800 }
1801
1802 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1803 {
1804 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1805
1806 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1807 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1808 {
1809 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1810
1811 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1812 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1813 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1814 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1815 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1816 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1817 }
1818 }
1819
1820 return TRUE;
1821
1822 error_return:
1823 if (dynbuf != NULL)
1824 free (dynbuf);
1825 return FALSE;
1826 }
1827
1828 /* Get version string. */
1829
1830 const char *
1831 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1832 bfd_boolean *hidden)
1833 {
1834 const char *version_string = NULL;
1835 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1836 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1837 {
1838 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1839
1840 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1841 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1842
1843 if (vernum == 0)
1844 version_string = "";
1845 else if (vernum == 1)
1846 version_string = "Base";
1847 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1848 version_string =
1849 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1850 else
1851 {
1852 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1853
1854 version_string = "";
1855 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1856 t != NULL;
1857 t = t->vn_nextref)
1858 {
1859 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1860
1861 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1862 {
1863 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1864 {
1865 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1866 break;
1867 }
1868 }
1869 }
1870 }
1871 }
1872 return version_string;
1873 }
1874
1875 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1876
1877 void
1878 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1879 void *filep,
1880 asymbol *symbol,
1881 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1882 {
1883 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1884 switch (how)
1885 {
1886 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1887 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1888 break;
1889 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1890 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1891 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1892 fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1893 break;
1894 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1895 {
1896 const char *section_name;
1897 const char *name = NULL;
1898 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1899 unsigned char st_other;
1900 bfd_vma val;
1901 const char *version_string;
1902 bfd_boolean hidden;
1903
1904 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1905
1906 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1907 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1908 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1909
1910 if (name == NULL)
1911 {
1912 name = symbol->name;
1913 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1914 }
1915
1916 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1917 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1918 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1919 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1920 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1921 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1922 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1923 else
1924 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1925 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1926
1927 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1928 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1929 symbol,
1930 &hidden);
1931 if (version_string)
1932 {
1933 if (!hidden)
1934 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1935 else
1936 {
1937 int i;
1938
1939 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1940 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1941 putc (' ', file);
1942 }
1943 }
1944
1945 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1946 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1947
1948 switch (st_other)
1949 {
1950 case 0: break;
1951 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1952 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1953 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1954 default:
1955 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1956 everything hex. */
1957 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1958 }
1959
1960 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1961 }
1962 break;
1963 }
1964 }
1965 \f
1966 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1967
1968 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1969
1970 bfd_boolean
1971 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1972 {
1973 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
1974 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
1975 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1976 const char *name;
1977 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
1978 static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
1979 static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
1980 static unsigned int nesting = 0;
1981
1982 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
1983 return FALSE;
1984
1985 if (++ nesting > 3)
1986 {
1987 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
1988 sections, with each the string indicies pointing to the next in the
1989 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
1990 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
1991 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
1992 can expect to recurse at least once.
1993
1994 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
1995 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
1996
1997 if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
1998 sections_being_created = NULL;
1999 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2000 {
2001 /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow. */
2002 sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
2003 bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
2004 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2005 }
2006 if (sections_being_created [shindex])
2007 {
2008 _bfd_error_handler
2009 (_("%B: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2010 return FALSE;
2011 }
2012 sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
2013 }
2014
2015 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2016 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2017 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2018 hdr->sh_name);
2019 if (name == NULL)
2020 goto fail;
2021
2022 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2023 switch (hdr->sh_type)
2024 {
2025 case SHT_NULL:
2026 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2027 goto success;
2028
2029 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2030 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2031 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2032 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2033 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2034 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2035 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2036 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2037 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2038 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2039 goto success;
2040
2041 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2042 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2043 goto fail;
2044
2045 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2046 {
2047 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2048 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2049 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2050 {
2051 case bfd_arch_i386:
2052 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2053 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2054 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2055 break;
2056 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2057 default:
2058 goto fail;
2059 }
2060 }
2061 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2062 goto fail;
2063 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2064 {
2065 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2066
2067 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2068 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2069 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2070 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2071 {
2072 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2073 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2074 }
2075 else
2076 {
2077 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2078
2079 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2080 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2081 {
2082 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2083 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2084 {
2085 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2086 break;
2087 }
2088 }
2089 }
2090 }
2091 goto success;
2092
2093 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2094 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2095 goto success;
2096
2097 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2098 goto fail;
2099
2100 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2101 {
2102 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2103 goto fail;
2104 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2105 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2106 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2107 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2108 goto success;
2109 }
2110
2111 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2112 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2113 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2114 {
2115 _bfd_error_handler
2116 /* xgettext:c-format */
2117 (_("%B: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2118 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2119 abfd, shindex);
2120 goto success;
2121 }
2122 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2123 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2124 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2125 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2126
2127 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2128 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2129 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2130 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2131 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2132 linker. */
2133 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2134 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2135 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2136 shindex))
2137 goto fail;
2138
2139 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2140 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2141 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2142 {
2143 elf_section_list * entry;
2144 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2145
2146 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2147 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2148 goto success;
2149
2150 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2151 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2152 {
2153 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2154
2155 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2156 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2157 break;
2158 }
2159
2160 if (i == num_sec)
2161 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2162 {
2163 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2164
2165 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2166 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2167 break;
2168 }
2169
2170 if (i != shindex)
2171 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2172 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2173 goto success;
2174 }
2175
2176 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2177 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2178 goto success;
2179
2180 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2181 goto fail;
2182
2183 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2184 {
2185 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2186 goto fail;
2187
2188 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2189 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2190 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2191 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2192 goto success;
2193 }
2194
2195 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2196 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2197 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2198 {
2199 _bfd_error_handler
2200 /* xgettext:c-format */
2201 (_("%B: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2202 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2203 abfd, shindex);
2204 goto success;
2205 }
2206 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2207 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2208 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2209 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2210
2211 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2212 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2213 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2214 goto success;
2215
2216 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2217 {
2218 elf_section_list * entry;
2219
2220 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2221 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2222 goto success;
2223
2224 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
2225 if (entry == NULL)
2226 goto fail;
2227 entry->ndx = shindex;
2228 entry->hdr = * hdr;
2229 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2230 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2231 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2232 goto success;
2233 }
2234
2235 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2236 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2237 goto success;
2238
2239 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2240 {
2241 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2242 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2243 goto success;
2244 }
2245
2246 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2247 {
2248 symtab_strtab:
2249 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2250 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2251 goto success;
2252 }
2253
2254 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2255 {
2256 dynsymtab_strtab:
2257 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2258 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2259 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2260 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2261 can handle it. */
2262 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2263 shindex);
2264 goto success;
2265 }
2266
2267 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2268 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2269 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2270 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2271 {
2272 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2273
2274 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2275 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2276 {
2277 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2278 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2279 {
2280 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2281 if (i == shindex)
2282 goto fail;
2283 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2284 goto fail;
2285 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2286 goto symtab_strtab;
2287 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2288 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2289 }
2290 }
2291 }
2292 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2293 goto success;
2294
2295 case SHT_REL:
2296 case SHT_RELA:
2297 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2298 {
2299 asection *target_sect;
2300 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2301 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2302 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2303
2304 if (hdr->sh_entsize
2305 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2306 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2307 goto fail;
2308
2309 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2310 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2311 {
2312 _bfd_error_handler
2313 /* xgettext:c-format */
2314 (_("%B: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2315 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2316 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2317 shindex);
2318 goto success;
2319 }
2320
2321 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2322 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2323 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2324 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2325 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2326 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2327 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2328
2329 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2330 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2331 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2332 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2333 {
2334 unsigned int scan;
2335 int found;
2336
2337 found = 0;
2338 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2339 {
2340 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2341 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2342 {
2343 if (found != 0)
2344 {
2345 found = 0;
2346 break;
2347 }
2348 found = scan;
2349 }
2350 }
2351 if (found != 0)
2352 hdr->sh_link = found;
2353 }
2354
2355 /* Get the symbol table. */
2356 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2357 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2358 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2359 goto fail;
2360
2361 /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2362 don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2363 represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2364 try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2365 can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2366 section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
2367 sh_link points to the null section. */
2368 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2369 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2370 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2371 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2372 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2373 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2374 {
2375 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2376 shindex);
2377 goto success;
2378 }
2379
2380 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2381 goto fail;
2382
2383 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2384 if (target_sect == NULL)
2385 goto fail;
2386
2387 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2388 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2389 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2390 else
2391 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2392
2393 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7. */
2394 if (*p_hdr != NULL)
2395 goto fail;
2396 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2397 if (hdr2 == NULL)
2398 goto fail;
2399 *hdr2 = *hdr;
2400 *p_hdr = hdr2;
2401 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2402 target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2403 * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2404 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2405 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2406 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2407 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2408 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2409 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2410 {
2411 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2412 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2413 }
2414 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2415 goto success;
2416 }
2417
2418 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2419 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2420 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2421 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2422 goto success;
2423
2424 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2425 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2426 goto fail;
2427
2428 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2429 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2430 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2431 goto success;
2432
2433 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2434 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2435 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2436 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2437 goto success;
2438
2439 case SHT_SHLIB:
2440 goto success;
2441
2442 case SHT_GROUP:
2443 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2444 goto fail;
2445
2446 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2447 goto fail;
2448
2449 goto success;
2450
2451 default:
2452 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2453 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2454 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2455 {
2456 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2457 goto fail;
2458 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2459 goto success;
2460 }
2461
2462 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2463 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2464 goto success;
2465
2466 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2467 {
2468 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2469 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2470 for applications? */
2471 _bfd_error_handler
2472 /* xgettext:c-format */
2473 (_("%B: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2474 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2475 else
2476 {
2477 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2478 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2479 shindex);
2480 goto success;
2481 }
2482 }
2483 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2484 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2485 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2486 _bfd_error_handler
2487 /* xgettext:c-format */
2488 (_("%B: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2489 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2490 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2491 {
2492 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2493 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2494 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2495 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2496 be rejected with an error message. */
2497 _bfd_error_handler
2498 /* xgettext:c-format */
2499 (_("%B: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2500 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2501 else
2502 {
2503 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2504 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2505 goto success;
2506 }
2507 }
2508 else
2509 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2510 _bfd_error_handler
2511 /* xgettext:c-format */
2512 (_("%B: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2513 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2514
2515 goto fail;
2516 }
2517
2518 fail:
2519 ret = FALSE;
2520 success:
2521 if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2522 sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2523 if (-- nesting == 0)
2524 {
2525 sections_being_created = NULL;
2526 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2527 }
2528 return ret;
2529 }
2530
2531 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2532
2533 Elf_Internal_Sym *
2534 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2535 bfd *abfd,
2536 unsigned long r_symndx)
2537 {
2538 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2539
2540 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2541 {
2542 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2543 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2544 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2545
2546 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2547 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2548 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2549 return NULL;
2550
2551 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2552 {
2553 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2554 cache->abfd = abfd;
2555 }
2556 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2557 }
2558
2559 return &cache->sym[ent];
2560 }
2561
2562 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2563 section. */
2564
2565 asection *
2566 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2567 {
2568 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2569 return NULL;
2570 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2571 }
2572
2573 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2574 {
2575 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2576 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2577 };
2578
2579 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2580 {
2581 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2582 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2583 };
2584
2585 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2586 {
2587 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2588 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2589 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2590 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2591 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2592 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2593 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2594 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2595 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2596 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2597 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2598 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2599 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2600 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2601 };
2602
2603 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2604 {
2605 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2606 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2607 { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2608 };
2609
2610 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2611 {
2612 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2613 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2614 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2615 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2616 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2617 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2618 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2619 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2620 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2621 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2622 };
2623
2624 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2625 {
2626 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2627 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2628 };
2629
2630 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2631 {
2632 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2633 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2634 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2635 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2636 };
2637
2638 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2639 {
2640 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2641 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2642 };
2643
2644 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2645 {
2646 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2647 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2648 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2649 };
2650
2651 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2652 {
2653 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2654 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2655 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2656 };
2657
2658 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2659 {
2660 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2661 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2662 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2663 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2664 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2665 };
2666
2667 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2668 {
2669 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2670 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2671 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2672 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2673 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2674 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2675 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2676 };
2677
2678 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2679 {
2680 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2681 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2682 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2683 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2684 };
2685
2686 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2687 {
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2690 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2691 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2692 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2693 };
2694
2695 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2696 {
2697 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2698 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2699 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2700 NULL, /* 'e' */
2701 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2702 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2703 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2704 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2705 NULL, /* 'j' */
2706 NULL, /* 'k' */
2707 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2708 NULL, /* 'm' */
2709 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2710 NULL, /* 'o' */
2711 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2712 NULL, /* 'q' */
2713 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2714 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2715 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2716 NULL, /* 'u' */
2717 NULL, /* 'v' */
2718 NULL, /* 'w' */
2719 NULL, /* 'x' */
2720 NULL, /* 'y' */
2721 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2722 };
2723
2724 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2725 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2726 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2727 unsigned int rela)
2728 {
2729 int i;
2730 int len;
2731
2732 len = strlen (name);
2733
2734 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2735 {
2736 int suffix_len;
2737 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2738
2739 if (len < prefix_len)
2740 continue;
2741 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2742 continue;
2743
2744 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2745 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2746 {
2747 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2748 {
2749 if (suffix_len == 0)
2750 continue;
2751 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2752 && (suffix_len == -2
2753 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2754 continue;
2755 }
2756 }
2757 else
2758 {
2759 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2760 continue;
2761 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2762 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2763 suffix_len) != 0)
2764 continue;
2765 }
2766 return &spec[i];
2767 }
2768
2769 return NULL;
2770 }
2771
2772 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2773 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2774 {
2775 int i;
2776 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2777 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2778
2779 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2780 if (sec->name == NULL)
2781 return NULL;
2782
2783 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2784 spec = bed->special_sections;
2785 if (spec)
2786 {
2787 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2788 bed->special_sections,
2789 sec->use_rela_p);
2790 if (spec != NULL)
2791 return spec;
2792 }
2793
2794 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2795 return NULL;
2796
2797 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2798 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2799 return NULL;
2800
2801 spec = special_sections[i];
2802
2803 if (spec == NULL)
2804 return NULL;
2805
2806 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2807 }
2808
2809 bfd_boolean
2810 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2811 {
2812 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2813 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2814 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2815
2816 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2817 if (sdata == NULL)
2818 {
2819 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2820 sizeof (*sdata));
2821 if (sdata == NULL)
2822 return FALSE;
2823 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2824 }
2825
2826 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2827 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2828 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2829
2830 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2831 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2832 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2833 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2834 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2835 elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2836 output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2837 sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2838 copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2839 if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2840 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2841 {
2842 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2843 if (ssect != NULL
2844 && (!sec->flags
2845 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2846 || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2847 || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2848 {
2849 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2850 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2851 }
2852 }
2853
2854 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2855 }
2856
2857 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2858
2859 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2860 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2861 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2862 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2863
2864 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2865 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2866 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2867 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2868 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2869 of combined data+bss.
2870
2871 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2872 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2873 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2874 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2875 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2876
2877 */
2878
2879 bfd_boolean
2880 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2881 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2882 int hdr_index,
2883 const char *type_name)
2884 {
2885 asection *newsect;
2886 char *name;
2887 char namebuf[64];
2888 size_t len;
2889 int split;
2890
2891 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2892 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2893 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2894
2895 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2896 {
2897 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2898 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2899 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2900 if (!name)
2901 return FALSE;
2902 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2903 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2904 if (newsect == NULL)
2905 return FALSE;
2906 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2907 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2908 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2909 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2910 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2911 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2912 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2913 {
2914 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2915 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2916 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2917 {
2918 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2919 may be data. */
2920 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2921 }
2922 }
2923 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2924 {
2925 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2926 }
2927 }
2928
2929 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2930 {
2931 bfd_vma align;
2932
2933 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2934 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2935 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2936 if (!name)
2937 return FALSE;
2938 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2939 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2940 if (newsect == NULL)
2941 return FALSE;
2942 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2943 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2944 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2945 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2946 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2947 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2948 align = hdr->p_align;
2949 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2950 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2951 {
2952 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2953 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2954 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2955 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2956 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2957 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2958 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2959 newsect->size = 0;
2960 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2961 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2962 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2963 }
2964 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2965 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2966 }
2967
2968 return TRUE;
2969 }
2970
2971 bfd_boolean
2972 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
2973 {
2974 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2975
2976 switch (hdr->p_type)
2977 {
2978 case PT_NULL:
2979 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
2980
2981 case PT_LOAD:
2982 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
2983
2984 case PT_DYNAMIC:
2985 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
2986
2987 case PT_INTERP:
2988 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
2989
2990 case PT_NOTE:
2991 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
2992 return FALSE;
2993 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz))
2994 return FALSE;
2995 return TRUE;
2996
2997 case PT_SHLIB:
2998 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
2999
3000 case PT_PHDR:
3001 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3002
3003 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3004 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3005 "eh_frame_hdr");
3006
3007 case PT_GNU_STACK:
3008 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3009
3010 case PT_GNU_RELRO:
3011 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3012
3013 default:
3014 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3015 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3016 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3017 }
3018 }
3019
3020 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3021 REL or RELA. */
3022
3023 Elf_Internal_Shdr *
3024 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3025 {
3026 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3027 {
3028 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3029 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3030 }
3031 else
3032 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3033 }
3034
3035 static bfd_boolean
3036 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3037 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3038 const char *sec_name,
3039 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
3040 {
3041 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3042 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3043 if (name == NULL)
3044 return FALSE;
3045
3046 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3047 rel_hdr->sh_name =
3048 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3049 FALSE);
3050 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3051 return FALSE;
3052
3053 return TRUE;
3054 }
3055
3056 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3057 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3058 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3059 relocations. */
3060
3061 static bfd_boolean
3062 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3063 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3064 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *sec_hdr,
3065 const char *sec_name,
3066 bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
3067 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
3068 {
3069 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3070 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3071
3072 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3073 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3074 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3075
3076 if (delay_st_name_p)
3077 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3078 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3079 use_rela_p))
3080 return FALSE;
3081 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3082 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3083 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3084 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3085 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3086 rel_hdr->sh_flags = sec_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP;
3087 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3088 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3089 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3090
3091 return TRUE;
3092 }
3093
3094 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3095
3096 int
3097 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3098 {
3099 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3100 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3101 return SHT_NOBITS;
3102 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3103 }
3104
3105 struct fake_section_arg
3106 {
3107 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3108 bfd_boolean failed;
3109 };
3110
3111 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3112
3113 static void
3114 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3115 {
3116 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3117 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3118 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3119 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3120 unsigned int sh_type;
3121 const char *name = asect->name;
3122 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
3123
3124 if (arg->failed)
3125 {
3126 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3127 loop. */
3128 return;
3129 }
3130
3131 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3132
3133 if (arg->link_info)
3134 {
3135 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3136 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3137 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3138 && name[1] == 'd'
3139 && name[6] == '_')
3140 {
3141 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3142 compressed. */
3143 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3144
3145 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3146 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3147 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3148 delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
3149 }
3150 }
3151 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3152 {
3153 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3154 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3155 {
3156 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3157 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3158 needed. */
3159 if (name[1] == 'z')
3160 {
3161 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3162 if (new_name == NULL)
3163 {
3164 arg->failed = TRUE;
3165 return;
3166 }
3167 name = new_name;
3168 }
3169 }
3170 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3171 {
3172 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3173 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3174 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3175 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3176 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3177 if (new_name == NULL)
3178 {
3179 arg->failed = TRUE;
3180 return;
3181 }
3182 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3183 name = new_name;
3184 }
3185 }
3186
3187 if (delay_st_name_p)
3188 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3189 else
3190 {
3191 this_hdr->sh_name
3192 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3193 name, FALSE);
3194 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3195 {
3196 arg->failed = TRUE;
3197 return;
3198 }
3199 }
3200
3201 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3202
3203 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3204 || asect->user_set_vma)
3205 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
3206 else
3207 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3208
3209 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3210 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3211 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3212 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3213 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3214 {
3215 _bfd_error_handler
3216 /* xgettext:c-format */
3217 (_("%B: error: Alignment power %d of section `%A' is too big"),
3218 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3219 arg->failed = TRUE;
3220 return;
3221 }
3222 this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
3223 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3224 copy_private_section_data. */
3225
3226 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3227 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3228
3229 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3230 asect->flags. */
3231 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3232 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3233 else
3234 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3235
3236 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3237 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3238 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3239 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3240 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3241 {
3242 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3243 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3244 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3245 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3246 _bfd_error_handler
3247 (_("warning: section `%A' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3248 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3249 }
3250
3251 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3252 {
3253 default:
3254 break;
3255
3256 case SHT_STRTAB:
3257 case SHT_NOTE:
3258 case SHT_NOBITS:
3259 case SHT_PROGBITS:
3260 break;
3261
3262 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3263 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3264 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3265 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3266 break;
3267
3268 case SHT_HASH:
3269 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3270 break;
3271
3272 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3273 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3274 break;
3275
3276 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3277 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3278 break;
3279
3280 case SHT_RELA:
3281 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3282 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3283 break;
3284
3285 case SHT_REL:
3286 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3287 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3288 break;
3289
3290 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3291 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3292 break;
3293
3294 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3295 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3296 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3297 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3298 zero. */
3299 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3300 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3301 else
3302 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3303 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3304 break;
3305
3306 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3307 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3308 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3309 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3310 zero. */
3311 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3312 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3313 else
3314 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3315 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3316 break;
3317
3318 case SHT_GROUP:
3319 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3320 break;
3321
3322 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3323 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3324 break;
3325 }
3326
3327 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3328 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3329 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3330 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3331 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3332 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3333 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3334 {
3335 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3336 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3337 }
3338 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3339 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3340 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3341 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3342 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3343 {
3344 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3345 if (asect->size == 0
3346 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3347 {
3348 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3349
3350 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3351 if (o != NULL)
3352 {
3353 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3354 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3355 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3356 }
3357 }
3358 }
3359 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3360 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3361
3362 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3363 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3364 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3365 create the other. */
3366 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3367 {
3368 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3369 needed. */
3370 if (arg->link_info
3371 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3372 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3373 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3374 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3375 {
3376 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3377 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, this_hdr, name,
3378 FALSE, delay_st_name_p))
3379 {
3380 arg->failed = TRUE;
3381 return;
3382 }
3383 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3384 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, this_hdr, name,
3385 TRUE, delay_st_name_p))
3386 {
3387 arg->failed = TRUE;
3388 return;
3389 }
3390 }
3391 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3392 (asect->use_rela_p
3393 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3394 this_hdr,
3395 name,
3396 asect->use_rela_p,
3397 delay_st_name_p))
3398 {
3399 arg->failed = TRUE;
3400 return;
3401 }
3402 }
3403
3404 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3405 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3406 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3407 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3408 {
3409 arg->failed = TRUE;
3410 return;
3411 }
3412
3413 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3414 {
3415 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3416 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3417 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3418 }
3419 }
3420
3421 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3422 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3423 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3424 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3425
3426 void
3427 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3428 {
3429 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3430 asection *elt, *first;
3431 unsigned char *loc;
3432 bfd_boolean gas;
3433
3434 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3435 elfxx-ia64.c. */
3436 if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
3437 || *failedptr)
3438 return;
3439
3440 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3441 {
3442 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3443
3444 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3445 generic linker. */
3446 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3447 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3448
3449 if (symindx == 0)
3450 {
3451 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3452 elf_section_syms. */
3453 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
3454 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3455 }
3456 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3457 }
3458 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3459 {
3460 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3461 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3462 set until all local symbols are output. */
3463 asection *igroup;
3464 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3465 unsigned long symndx;
3466 unsigned long extsymoff;
3467 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3468
3469 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3470 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3471 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3472 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3473 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3474 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3475 extsymoff = 0;
3476 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3477 {
3478 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3479
3480 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3481 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3482 }
3483 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3484 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3485 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3486 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3487
3488 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3489 }
3490
3491 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3492 gas = TRUE;
3493 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3494 {
3495 gas = FALSE;
3496 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3497
3498 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3499 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3500 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3501 {
3502 *failedptr = TRUE;
3503 return;
3504 }
3505 }
3506
3507 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3508
3509 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3510 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3511 start of the input section group. */
3512 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3513
3514 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3515 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3516 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3517 directives, not that it matters. */
3518 while (elt != NULL)
3519 {
3520 asection *s;
3521
3522 s = elt;
3523 if (!gas)
3524 s = s->output_section;
3525 if (s != NULL
3526 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3527 {
3528 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3529 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL)
3530 {
3531 loc -= 4;
3532 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3533 }
3534 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL)
3535 {
3536 loc -= 4;
3537 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3538 }
3539 loc -= 4;
3540 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3541 }
3542 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3543 if (elt == first)
3544 break;
3545 }
3546
3547 loc -= 4;
3548 BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3549
3550 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3551 }
3552
3553 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3554 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3555 relocations apply. */
3556
3557 asection *
3558 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3559 {
3560 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3561 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3562 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3563 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3564 {
3565 asection *sec;
3566
3567 name = ".got.plt";
3568 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3569 if (sec != NULL)
3570 return sec;
3571 name = ".got";
3572 }
3573
3574 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3575 }
3576
3577 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3578
3579 static asection *
3580 elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3581 {
3582 const char *name;
3583 unsigned int type;
3584 bfd *abfd;
3585 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3586
3587 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3588 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3589 return NULL;
3590
3591 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3592 name = reloc_sec->name;
3593 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3594 return NULL;
3595 name += 4;
3596 if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3597 return NULL;
3598
3599 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3600 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3601 return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3602 }
3603
3604 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3605 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3606 in here too, while we're at it. */
3607
3608 static bfd_boolean
3609 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3610 {
3611 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3612 asection *sec;
3613 unsigned int section_number;
3614 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3615 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3616 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3617
3618 section_number = 1;
3619
3620 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3621
3622 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3623 if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3624 {
3625 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3626
3627 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3628 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3629 {
3630 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3631
3632 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3633 {
3634 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3635 {
3636 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3637 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3638 abfd->section_count--;
3639 }
3640 else
3641 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3642 }
3643
3644 /* Count relocations. */
3645 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3646 }
3647
3648 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3649 if (reloc_count == 0)
3650 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3651 }
3652
3653 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3654 {
3655 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3656
3657 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3658 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3659 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3660 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3661 if (d->rel.hdr)
3662 {
3663 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3664 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3665 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3666 }
3667 else
3668 d->rel.idx = 0;
3669
3670 if (d->rela.hdr)
3671 {
3672 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3673 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3674 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3675 }
3676 else
3677 d->rela.idx = 0;
3678 }
3679
3680 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3681 || (link_info == NULL
3682 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3683 == HAS_RELOC)));
3684 if (need_symtab)
3685 {
3686 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3687 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3688 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3689 {
3690 elf_section_list * entry;
3691
3692 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3693
3694 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
3695 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3696 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3697 entry->hdr.sh_name
3698 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3699 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3700 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3701 return FALSE;
3702 }
3703 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3704 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3705 }
3706
3707 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3708 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3709 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3710
3711 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3712 {
3713 /* xgettext:c-format */
3714 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: too many sections: %u"),
3715 abfd, section_number);
3716 return FALSE;
3717 }
3718
3719 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3720 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3721
3722 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3723 indices. */
3724 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3725 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3726 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3727 return FALSE;
3728
3729 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3730 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3731 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3732 {
3733 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3734 return FALSE;
3735 }
3736
3737 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3738
3739 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3740 if (need_symtab)
3741 {
3742 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3743 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3744 {
3745 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3746 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3747 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3748 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3749 }
3750 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3751 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3752 }
3753
3754 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3755 {
3756 asection *s;
3757
3758 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3759
3760 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3761 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3762 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3763 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3764 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3765
3766 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3767
3768 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3769 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3770 the relocation entries apply. */
3771 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3772 {
3773 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3774 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3775 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3776 }
3777 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3778 {
3779 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3780 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3781 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3782 }
3783
3784 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3785 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3786 {
3787 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3788 if (s)
3789 {
3790 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3791 if (link_info != NULL)
3792 {
3793 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3794 if (discarded_section (s))
3795 {
3796 asection *kept;
3797 _bfd_error_handler
3798 /* xgettext:c-format */
3799 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to"
3800 " discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
3801 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3802 s, s->owner);
3803 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3804 size as the discarded one. */
3805 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3806 if (kept == NULL)
3807 {
3808 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3809 return FALSE;
3810 }
3811 s = kept;
3812 }
3813
3814 s = s->output_section;
3815 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3816 }
3817 else
3818 {
3819 /* Handle objcopy. */
3820 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3821 {
3822 _bfd_error_handler
3823 /* xgettext:c-format */
3824 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to"
3825 " removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
3826 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3827 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3828 return FALSE;
3829 }
3830 s = s->output_section;
3831 }
3832 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3833 }
3834 else
3835 {
3836 /* PR 290:
3837 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3838 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3839 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3840 where s is NULL. */
3841 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3842 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3843 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3844 bed->link_order_error_handler
3845 /* xgettext:c-format */
3846 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
3847 abfd, sec);
3848 }
3849 }
3850
3851 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3852 {
3853 case SHT_REL:
3854 case SHT_RELA:
3855 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3856 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3857 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3858 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3859 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3860 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3861 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3862 if (s != NULL)
3863 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3864
3865 s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3866 if (s != NULL)
3867 {
3868 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3869 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3870 }
3871 break;
3872
3873 case SHT_STRTAB:
3874 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3875 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3876 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3877 field to point to this section. */
3878 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3879 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3880 {
3881 size_t len;
3882 char *alc;
3883
3884 len = strlen (sec->name);
3885 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3886 if (alc == NULL)
3887 return FALSE;
3888 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3889 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3890 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3891 free (alc);
3892 if (s != NULL)
3893 {
3894 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3895
3896 /* This is a .stab section. */
3897 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3898 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3899 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3900 }
3901 }
3902 break;
3903
3904 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3905 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3906 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3907 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3908 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3909 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3910 version strings. */
3911 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3912 if (s != NULL)
3913 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3914 break;
3915
3916 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3917 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3918 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3919 the version strings. */
3920 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3921 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3922 if (s != NULL)
3923 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3924 break;
3925
3926 case SHT_HASH:
3927 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3928 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3929 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3930 this hash table or version table is for. */
3931 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3932 if (s != NULL)
3933 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3934 break;
3935
3936 case SHT_GROUP:
3937 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3938 }
3939 }
3940
3941 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
3942 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
3943 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
3944
3945 return TRUE;
3946 }
3947
3948 static bfd_boolean
3949 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3950 {
3951 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3952 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3953 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3954 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3955
3956 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3957 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3958 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3959 }
3960
3961 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
3962 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
3963 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
3964 the beginning of that array.
3965
3966 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
3967
3968 unsigned int
3969 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3970 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
3971 {
3972 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
3973
3974 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
3975 {
3976 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
3977 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
3978 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
3979
3980 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3981 continue;
3982
3983 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
3984 if (h == NULL)
3985 continue;
3986 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3987 continue;
3988 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
3989 continue;
3990
3991 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
3992 }
3993
3994 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
3995
3996 return dst_count;
3997 }
3998
3999 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4000 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4001
4002 static bfd_boolean
4003 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4004 {
4005 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4006
4007 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4008 return FALSE;
4009
4010 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
4011 return ((type_ptr != NULL
4012 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4013 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4014 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4015 || (sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4016 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4017 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4018 }
4019
4020 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4021 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4022
4023 static bfd_boolean
4024 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4025 {
4026 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4027 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4028 asymbol **sect_syms;
4029 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4030 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4031 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4032 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4033 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4034 unsigned int idx;
4035 asection *asect;
4036 asymbol **new_syms;
4037
4038 #ifdef DEBUG
4039 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4040 fflush (stderr);
4041 #endif
4042
4043 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4044 {
4045 if (max_index < asect->index)
4046 max_index = asect->index;
4047 }
4048
4049 max_index++;
4050 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
4051 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4052 return FALSE;
4053 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4054 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4055
4056 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4057 decided to output. */
4058 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4059 {
4060 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4061
4062 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4063 && sym->value == 0
4064 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4065 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4066 {
4067 asection *sec = sym->section;
4068
4069 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4070 sec = sec->output_section;
4071
4072 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4073 }
4074 }
4075
4076 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4077 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4078 {
4079 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4080 num_globals++;
4081 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4082 num_locals++;
4083 }
4084
4085 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4086 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4087 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4088 at least in that case. */
4089 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4090 {
4091 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4092 {
4093 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4094 num_locals++;
4095 else
4096 num_globals++;
4097 }
4098 }
4099
4100 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4101 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
4102 sizeof (asymbol *));
4103
4104 if (new_syms == NULL)
4105 return FALSE;
4106
4107 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4108 {
4109 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4110 unsigned int i;
4111
4112 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4113 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4114 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4115 i = num_locals2++;
4116 else
4117 continue;
4118 new_syms[i] = sym;
4119 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4120 }
4121 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4122 {
4123 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4124 {
4125 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4126 unsigned int i;
4127
4128 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4129 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4130 i = num_locals2++;
4131 else
4132 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4133 new_syms[i] = sym;
4134 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4135 }
4136 }
4137
4138 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4139
4140 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4141 return TRUE;
4142 }
4143
4144 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4145 ELF data structure. */
4146
4147 static inline file_ptr
4148 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4149 {
4150 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4151 }
4152
4153 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4154 required section alignment. */
4155
4156 file_ptr
4157 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4158 file_ptr offset,
4159 bfd_boolean align)
4160 {
4161 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4162 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4163 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4164 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4165 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4166 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4167 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4168 return offset;
4169 }
4170
4171 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4172 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4173 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4174
4175 bfd_boolean
4176 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4177 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4178 {
4179 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4180 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4181 bfd_boolean failed;
4182 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4183 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4184 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
4185
4186 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4187 return TRUE;
4188
4189 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4190 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4191 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4192
4193 if (! prep_headers (abfd))
4194 return FALSE;
4195
4196 /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
4197 (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
4198
4199 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
4200 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4201 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4202 if (fsargs.failed)
4203 return FALSE;
4204
4205 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4206 return FALSE;
4207
4208 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4209 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4210 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4211 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4212 == HAS_RELOC)));
4213 if (need_symtab)
4214 {
4215 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4216 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4217
4218 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
4219 return FALSE;
4220 }
4221
4222 failed = FALSE;
4223 if (link_info == NULL)
4224 {
4225 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4226 if (failed)
4227 return FALSE;
4228 }
4229
4230 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4231 /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
4232 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4233 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4234 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4235 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4236 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4237 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4238 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4239 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4240 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4241
4242 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4243 return FALSE;
4244
4245 if (need_symtab)
4246 {
4247 file_ptr off;
4248 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4249
4250 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4251
4252 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4253 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4254
4255 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4256 {
4257 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4258 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4259 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4260 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4261 }
4262
4263 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4264 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4265
4266 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4267
4268 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4269 out. */
4270 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4271 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4272 return FALSE;
4273 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4274 }
4275
4276 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
4277
4278 return TRUE;
4279 }
4280
4281 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4282 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4283
4284 static bfd_size_type
4285 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4286 {
4287 size_t segs;
4288 asection *s;
4289 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4290
4291 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4292 and one for data. */
4293 segs = 2;
4294
4295 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4296 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4297 {
4298 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4299 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4300 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4301 targets. */
4302 segs += 2;
4303 }
4304
4305 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4306 {
4307 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4308 ++segs;
4309 }
4310
4311 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4312 {
4313 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4314 ++segs;
4315 }
4316
4317 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4318 {
4319 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4320 ++segs;
4321 }
4322
4323 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4324 {
4325 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4326 ++segs;
4327 }
4328
4329 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4330 {
4331 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4332 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4333 {
4334 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4335 ++segs;
4336 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
4337 for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
4338 gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
4339 (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4340 each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
4341 so we check whether the sections are correctly
4342 aligned. */
4343 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4344 while (s->next != NULL
4345 && s->next->alignment_power == 2
4346 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4347 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
4348 s = s->next;
4349 }
4350 }
4351
4352 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4353 {
4354 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4355 {
4356 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4357 ++segs;
4358 break;
4359 }
4360 }
4361
4362 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4363
4364 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4365 {
4366 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4367 unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
4368 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4369 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4370 {
4371 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4372 > PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
4373 {
4374 _bfd_error_handler
4375 /* xgettext:c-format */
4376 (_("%B: GNU_MBIN section `%A' has invalid sh_info field: %d"),
4377 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4378 continue;
4379 }
4380 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4381 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4382 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4383 segs ++;
4384 }
4385 }
4386
4387 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4388 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4389 {
4390 int a;
4391
4392 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4393 if (a == -1)
4394 abort ();
4395 segs += a;
4396 }
4397
4398 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4399 }
4400
4401 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4402
4403 Elf_Internal_Phdr *
4404 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4405 {
4406 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4407 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4408
4409 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4410 m != NULL;
4411 m = m->next, p++)
4412 {
4413 int i;
4414
4415 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4416 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4417 return p;
4418 }
4419
4420 return NULL;
4421 }
4422
4423 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4424
4425 static struct elf_segment_map *
4426 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4427 asection **sections,
4428 unsigned int from,
4429 unsigned int to,
4430 bfd_boolean phdr)
4431 {
4432 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4433 unsigned int i;
4434 asection **hdrpp;
4435 bfd_size_type amt;
4436
4437 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4438 amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4439 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4440 if (m == NULL)
4441 return NULL;
4442 m->next = NULL;
4443 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4444 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4445 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4446 m->count = to - from;
4447
4448 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4449 {
4450 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4451 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4452 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4453 }
4454
4455 return m;
4456 }
4457
4458 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4459 on failure. */
4460
4461 struct elf_segment_map *
4462 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4463 {
4464 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4465
4466 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4467 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4468 if (m == NULL)
4469 return NULL;
4470 m->next = NULL;
4471 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4472 m->count = 1;
4473 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4474
4475 return m;
4476 }
4477
4478 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4479
4480 static bfd_boolean
4481 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4482 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4483 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4484 {
4485 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4486 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4487
4488 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4489 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4490 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4491 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4492 removed. */
4493 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4494 while (*m)
4495 {
4496 unsigned int i, new_count;
4497
4498 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4499 {
4500 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4501 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4502 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4503 {
4504 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4505 new_count++;
4506 }
4507 }
4508 (*m)->count = new_count;
4509
4510 if (remove_empty_load
4511 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4512 && (*m)->count == 0
4513 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4514 *m = (*m)->next;
4515 else
4516 m = &(*m)->next;
4517 }
4518
4519 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4520 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4521 {
4522 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4523 return FALSE;
4524 }
4525
4526 return TRUE;
4527 }
4528
4529 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4530
4531 bfd_boolean
4532 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4533 {
4534 unsigned int count;
4535 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4536 asection **sections = NULL;
4537 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4538 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4539
4540 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4541
4542 if (info != NULL)
4543 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4544
4545 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4546 {
4547 asection *s;
4548 unsigned int i;
4549 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4550 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4551 asection *last_hdr;
4552 bfd_vma last_size;
4553 unsigned int phdr_index;
4554 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4555 asection **hdrpp;
4556 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4557 bfd_boolean writable;
4558 int tls_count = 0;
4559 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4560 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4561 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4562 bfd_size_type amt;
4563 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
4564 bfd_boolean linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = FALSE;
4565
4566 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4567
4568 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
4569 sizeof (asection *));
4570 if (sections == NULL)
4571 goto error_return;
4572
4573 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4574 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4575 being shifted. */
4576 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4577 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4578
4579 i = 0;
4580 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4581 {
4582 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4583 {
4584 sections[i] = s;
4585 ++i;
4586 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4587 if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4588 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
4589 }
4590 }
4591 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4592 count = i;
4593
4594 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4595
4596 /* Build the mapping. */
4597
4598 mfirst = NULL;
4599 pm = &mfirst;
4600
4601 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4602 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4603 section. */
4604 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4605 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4606 {
4607 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4608 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4609 if (m == NULL)
4610 goto error_return;
4611 m->next = NULL;
4612 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4613 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4614 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4615 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4616 linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = TRUE;
4617 *pm = m;
4618 pm = &m->next;
4619
4620 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4621 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4622 if (m == NULL)
4623 goto error_return;
4624 m->next = NULL;
4625 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4626 m->count = 1;
4627 m->sections[0] = s;
4628
4629 *pm = m;
4630 pm = &m->next;
4631 }
4632
4633 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4634 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4635 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4636 last_hdr = NULL;
4637 last_size = 0;
4638 phdr_index = 0;
4639 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4640 /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
4641 Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
4642 FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ? */
4643 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4644 maxpagesize = 1;
4645 writable = FALSE;
4646 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4647 if (dynsec != NULL
4648 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4649 dynsec = NULL;
4650
4651 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4652 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4653 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4654 program headers we will need. */
4655 if (count > 0)
4656 {
4657 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4658
4659 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4660 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4661 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4662 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4663 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
4664 || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
4665 < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
4666 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
4667 {
4668 /* PR 20815: The ELF standard says that a PT_PHDR segment, if
4669 present, must be included as part of the memory image of the
4670 program. Ie it must be part of a PT_LOAD segment as well.
4671 If we have had to create our own PT_PHDR segment, but it is
4672 not going to be covered by the first PT_LOAD segment, then
4673 force the inclusion if we can... */
4674 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4675 && linker_created_pt_phdr_segment)
4676 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4677 else
4678 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4679 }
4680 }
4681
4682 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4683 {
4684 asection *hdr;
4685 bfd_boolean new_segment;
4686
4687 hdr = *hdrpp;
4688
4689 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4690 segment. */
4691
4692 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4693 {
4694 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4695 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4696 new_segment = FALSE;
4697 }
4698 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4699 {
4700 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4701 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4702 segment. */
4703 new_segment = TRUE;
4704 }
4705 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4706 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4707 {
4708 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4709 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4710 new_segment = TRUE;
4711 }
4712 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4713 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4714 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4715 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4716 section can be included in the current segment. */
4717 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
4718 > last_hdr->lma)
4719 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
4720 <= hdr->lma))
4721 {
4722 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4723 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4724 new_segment = TRUE;
4725 }
4726 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4727 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0
4728 && ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4729 || (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4730 != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize))))
4731 {
4732 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4733 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4734 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4735 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose.
4736 However, like the writable/non-writable case below,
4737 if they are on the same page then they must be put
4738 in the same segment. */
4739 new_segment = TRUE;
4740 }
4741 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4742 {
4743 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4744 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4745 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4746 new_segment = FALSE;
4747 }
4748 else if (! writable
4749 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
4750 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4751 != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4752 {
4753 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4754 segment, unless they are on the same page in memory
4755 anyhow. We already know that the last section does not
4756 bring us past the current section on the page, so the
4757 only case in which the new section is not on the same
4758 page as the previous section is when the previous section
4759 ends precisely on a page boundary. */
4760 new_segment = TRUE;
4761 }
4762 else
4763 {
4764 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4765 new_segment = FALSE;
4766 }
4767
4768 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4769 if (last_hdr != NULL
4770 && info != NULL
4771 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4772 new_segment
4773 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4774 last_hdr,
4775 new_segment);
4776
4777 if (! new_segment)
4778 {
4779 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4780 writable = TRUE;
4781 last_hdr = hdr;
4782 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4783 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4784 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4785 last_size = hdr->size;
4786 else
4787 last_size = 0;
4788 continue;
4789 }
4790
4791 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4792 header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4793
4794 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4795 if (m == NULL)
4796 goto error_return;
4797
4798 *pm = m;
4799 pm = &m->next;
4800
4801 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4802 writable = TRUE;
4803 else
4804 writable = FALSE;
4805
4806 last_hdr = hdr;
4807 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4808 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4809 last_size = hdr->size;
4810 else
4811 last_size = 0;
4812 phdr_index = i;
4813 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4814 }
4815
4816 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4817 for .tbss. */
4818 if (last_hdr != NULL
4819 && (i - phdr_index != 1
4820 || ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4821 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
4822 {
4823 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4824 if (m == NULL)
4825 goto error_return;
4826
4827 *pm = m;
4828 pm = &m->next;
4829 }
4830
4831 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4832 if (dynsec != NULL)
4833 {
4834 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4835 if (m == NULL)
4836 goto error_return;
4837 *pm = m;
4838 pm = &m->next;
4839 }
4840
4841 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4842 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4843 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4844 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4845 in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4846 bogus anyhow. */
4847 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4848 {
4849 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4850 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4851 {
4852 asection *s2;
4853
4854 count = 1;
4855 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4856 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4857 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4858 {
4859 if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4860 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4861 && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4862 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4863 == s2->next->lma)
4864 count++;
4865 else
4866 break;
4867 }
4868 amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4869 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4870 if (m == NULL)
4871 goto error_return;
4872 m->next = NULL;
4873 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4874 m->count = count;
4875 while (count > 1)
4876 {
4877 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4878 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4879 s = s->next;
4880 }
4881 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4882 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4883 *pm = m;
4884 pm = &m->next;
4885 }
4886 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4887 {
4888 if (! tls_count)
4889 first_tls = s;
4890 tls_count++;
4891 }
4892 if (first_mbind == NULL
4893 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
4894 first_mbind = s;
4895 }
4896
4897 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4898 if (tls_count > 0)
4899 {
4900 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4901 amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4902 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4903 if (m == NULL)
4904 goto error_return;
4905 m->next = NULL;
4906 m->p_type = PT_TLS;
4907 m->count = tls_count;
4908 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4909 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4910 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4911 s = first_tls;
4912 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4913 {
4914 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
4915 {
4916 _bfd_error_handler
4917 (_("%B: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
4918 s = first_tls;
4919 i = 0;
4920 while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
4921 {
4922 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
4923 {
4924 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %A"), s);
4925 i++;
4926 }
4927 else
4928 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %A"), s);
4929 s = s->next;
4930 }
4931 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4932 goto error_return;
4933 }
4934 m->sections[i] = s;
4935 s = s->next;
4936 }
4937
4938 *pm = m;
4939 pm = &m->next;
4940 }
4941
4942 if (first_mbind && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4943 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4944 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
4945 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4946 <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM))
4947 {
4948 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4949 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
4950 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4951 p_flags |= PF_W;
4952 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4953 p_flags |= PF_X;
4954
4955 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
4956 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4957 if (m == NULL)
4958 goto error_return;
4959 m->next = NULL;
4960 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
4961 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4962 m->count = 1;
4963 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4964 m->sections[0] = s;
4965 m->p_flags = p_flags;
4966
4967 *pm = m;
4968 pm = &m->next;
4969 }
4970
4971 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
4972 segment. */
4973 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
4974 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
4975 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4976 {
4977 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4978 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4979 if (m == NULL)
4980 goto error_return;
4981 m->next = NULL;
4982 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
4983 m->count = 1;
4984 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
4985
4986 *pm = m;
4987 pm = &m->next;
4988 }
4989
4990 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4991 {
4992 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4993 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4994 if (m == NULL)
4995 goto error_return;
4996 m->next = NULL;
4997 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
4998 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
4999 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5000 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5001 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5002 if (info->stacksize > 0)
5003 {
5004 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5005 m->p_size_valid = 1;
5006 }
5007
5008 *pm = m;
5009 pm = &m->next;
5010 }
5011
5012 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5013 {
5014 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5015 {
5016 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5017 && m->count != 0
5018 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5019 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5020 {
5021 i = m->count;
5022 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5023 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5024 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5025 break;
5026
5027 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5028 break;
5029 }
5030 }
5031
5032 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5033 if (m != NULL)
5034 {
5035 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5036 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5037 if (m == NULL)
5038 goto error_return;
5039 m->next = NULL;
5040 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5041 *pm = m;
5042 pm = &m->next;
5043 }
5044 }
5045
5046 free (sections);
5047 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5048 }
5049
5050 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5051 return FALSE;
5052
5053 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5054 ++count;
5055 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5056
5057 return TRUE;
5058
5059 error_return:
5060 if (sections != NULL)
5061 free (sections);
5062 return FALSE;
5063 }
5064
5065 /* Sort sections by address. */
5066
5067 static int
5068 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5069 {
5070 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5071 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5072 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5073
5074 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5075 place the section into a segment. */
5076 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5077 return -1;
5078 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5079 return 1;
5080
5081 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5082 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5083 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5084 return -1;
5085 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5086 return 1;
5087
5088 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5089
5090 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5091
5092 if (TOEND (sec1))
5093 {
5094 if (TOEND (sec2))
5095 {
5096 /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
5097 here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
5098 if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
5099 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5100 }
5101 else
5102 return 1;
5103 }
5104 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5105 return -1;
5106
5107 #undef TOEND
5108
5109 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5110 before others at the same address. */
5111
5112 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5113 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5114
5115 if (size1 < size2)
5116 return -1;
5117 if (size1 > size2)
5118 return 1;
5119
5120 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5121 }
5122
5123 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5124
5125 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5126 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5127 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5128 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5129 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5130 which is wrong.
5131
5132 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5133 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5134 the page size.'' */
5135 /* In other words, something like:
5136
5137 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5138 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5139 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5140 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5141 else
5142 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5143
5144 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5145
5146 static file_ptr
5147 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5148 {
5149 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5150 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5151 maxpagesize = 1;
5152 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5153 }
5154
5155 static void
5156 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5157 {
5158 unsigned int j;
5159 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5160 char buf[32];
5161
5162 if (pt == NULL)
5163 {
5164 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5165 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5166 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5167 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5168 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5169 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5170 else
5171 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5172 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5173 pt = buf;
5174 }
5175 fflush (stdout);
5176 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5177 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5178 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5179 putc ('\n',stderr);
5180 fflush (stderr);
5181 }
5182
5183 static bfd_boolean
5184 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5185 {
5186 void *buf;
5187 bfd_boolean ret;
5188
5189 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5190 return FALSE;
5191 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5192 if (buf == NULL)
5193 return FALSE;
5194 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5195 free (buf);
5196 return ret;
5197 }
5198
5199 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5200 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5201 the file header. */
5202
5203 static bfd_boolean
5204 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5205 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5206 {
5207 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5208 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5209 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5210 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5211 file_ptr off;
5212 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5213 unsigned int pt_load_count = 0;
5214 unsigned int alloc;
5215 unsigned int i, j;
5216 bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
5217
5218 if (link_info == NULL
5219 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5220 return FALSE;
5221
5222 alloc = 0;
5223 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5224 {
5225 ++alloc;
5226 if (m->header_size)
5227 header_pad = m->header_size;
5228 }
5229
5230 if (alloc)
5231 {
5232 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5233 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5234 }
5235 else
5236 {
5237 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5238 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5239 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5240 }
5241
5242 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5243
5244 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5245 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5246 else
5247 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5248 >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5249
5250 if (alloc == 0)
5251 {
5252 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5253 return TRUE;
5254 }
5255
5256 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5257 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5258 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5259 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5260 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5261 layout.
5262 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5263 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5264 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5265 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
5266 == 0);
5267 phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
5268 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
5269 (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
5270 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
5271 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5272 if (phdrs == NULL)
5273 return FALSE;
5274
5275 maxpagesize = 1;
5276 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5277 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5278
5279 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5280 off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5281 if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
5282 header_pad = 0;
5283 else
5284 header_pad -= off;
5285 off += header_pad;
5286
5287 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
5288 m != NULL;
5289 m = m->next, p++, j++)
5290 {
5291 asection **secpp;
5292 bfd_vma off_adjust;
5293 bfd_boolean no_contents;
5294
5295 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5296 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5297 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5298 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5299 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5300 if (m->count > 1
5301 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5302 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5303 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5304 elf_sort_sections);
5305
5306 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5307 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5308 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5309 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5310 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5311 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5312 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5313
5314 if (m->count == 0)
5315 p->p_vaddr = 0;
5316 else
5317 p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5318
5319 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5320 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5321 else if (m->count == 0)
5322 p->p_paddr = 0;
5323 else
5324 p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5325
5326 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5327 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5328 {
5329 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5330 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5331 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5332 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5333 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5334 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5335 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5336 segment. */
5337 if (m->p_align_valid)
5338 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5339
5340 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5341 pt_load_count += 1;
5342 }
5343 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5344 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5345 else if (m->count == 0)
5346 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5347 else
5348 p->p_align = 0;
5349
5350 no_contents = FALSE;
5351 off_adjust = 0;
5352 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5353 && m->count > 0)
5354 {
5355 bfd_size_type align;
5356 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5357
5358 if (m->p_align_valid)
5359 align = p->p_align;
5360 else
5361 {
5362 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5363 {
5364 unsigned int secalign;
5365
5366 secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
5367 if (secalign > align_power)
5368 align_power = secalign;
5369 }
5370 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5371 if (align < maxpagesize)
5372 align = maxpagesize;
5373 }
5374
5375 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5376 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5377 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5378 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5379 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5380 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5381
5382 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5383 sections. */
5384 no_contents = TRUE;
5385 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5386 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5387 {
5388 no_contents = FALSE;
5389 break;
5390 }
5391
5392 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
5393
5394 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5395 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5396 processors. */
5397 if (pt_load_count > 1
5398 && bed->no_page_alias
5399 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5400 && (off & -maxpagesize) == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize))
5401 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5402 off += off_adjust;
5403 if (no_contents)
5404 {
5405 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5406 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5407 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5408 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5409 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5410 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5411 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5412 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5413 }
5414 else
5415 off_adjust = 0;
5416 }
5417 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5418 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5419 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5420 && m->count > 1
5421 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5422 {
5423 _bfd_error_handler
5424 (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5425 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5426 abfd);
5427 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5428 return FALSE;
5429 }
5430 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5431 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5432 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5433 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5434
5435 p->p_offset = 0;
5436 p->p_filesz = 0;
5437 p->p_memsz = 0;
5438
5439 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5440 {
5441 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5442 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5443 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5444 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5445 if (m->count > 0)
5446 {
5447 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5448 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5449 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5450 {
5451 _bfd_error_handler
5452 (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers,"
5453 " try linking with -N"),
5454 abfd);
5455 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5456 return FALSE;
5457 }
5458
5459 p->p_vaddr -= off;
5460 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5461 p->p_paddr -= off;
5462 }
5463 }
5464
5465 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5466 {
5467 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5468 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5469
5470 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5471 {
5472 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5473
5474 if (m->count > 0)
5475 {
5476 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5477 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5478 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5479 }
5480 }
5481
5482 p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5483 p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5484 if (m->count)
5485 {
5486 p->p_filesz += header_pad;
5487 p->p_memsz += header_pad;
5488 }
5489 }
5490
5491 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5492 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5493 {
5494 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5495 p->p_offset = off;
5496 else
5497 {
5498 file_ptr adjust;
5499
5500 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5501 if (!no_contents)
5502 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5503 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5504 }
5505 }
5506
5507 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5508 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5509 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5510 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5511 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5512 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5513 {
5514 asection *sec;
5515 bfd_size_type align;
5516 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5517
5518 sec = *secpp;
5519 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5520 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
5521
5522 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5523 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5524 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5525 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5526 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5527 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5528 {
5529 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
5530 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
5531 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
5532 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
5533
5534 if (adjust != 0
5535 && (s_start < p_end
5536 || p_end < p_start))
5537 {
5538 _bfd_error_handler
5539 /* xgettext:c-format */
5540 (_("%B: section %A lma %#Lx adjusted to %#Lx"),
5541 abfd, sec, s_start, p_end);
5542 adjust = 0;
5543 sec->lma = p_end;
5544 }
5545 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5546
5547 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5548 {
5549 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5550 {
5551 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5552 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5553 zero it. */
5554 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5555 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5556 return FALSE;
5557 }
5558 off += adjust;
5559 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5560 }
5561 }
5562
5563 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5564 {
5565 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5566 everything. */
5567 if (i == 0)
5568 {
5569 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5570 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5571 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5572 p->p_memsz = 0;
5573 p->p_align = 1;
5574 }
5575 else
5576 {
5577 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5578 sec->filepos = 0;
5579 sec->size = 0;
5580 sec->flags = 0;
5581 continue;
5582 }
5583 }
5584 else
5585 {
5586 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5587 {
5588 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5589 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5590 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5591 }
5592 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5593 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5594 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5595 {
5596 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5597 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5598 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5599 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5600 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5601 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5602 p_offset value. */
5603 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5604 off, align);
5605 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5606 }
5607
5608 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5609 {
5610 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5611 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5612 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5613 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5614 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5615 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5616 }
5617 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5618 {
5619 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5620 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5621
5622 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5623 normal segments. */
5624 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5625 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5626 }
5627
5628 if (align > p->p_align
5629 && !m->p_align_valid
5630 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5631 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5632 p->p_align = align;
5633 }
5634
5635 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5636 {
5637 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5638 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5639 p->p_flags |= PF_X;
5640 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5641 p->p_flags |= PF_W;
5642 }
5643 }
5644
5645 off -= off_adjust;
5646
5647 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5648 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5649 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5650 {
5651 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5652
5653 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5654 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5655 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5656 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5657 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5658 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5659 {
5660 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5661 check_vma = FALSE;
5662 break;
5663 }
5664
5665 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5666 {
5667 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5668 asection *sec;
5669
5670 sec = m->sections[i];
5671 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5672 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5673 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5674 {
5675 _bfd_error_handler
5676 /* xgettext:c-format */
5677 (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5678 abfd, sec, j);
5679 print_segment_map (m);
5680 }
5681 }
5682 }
5683 }
5684
5685 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5686 return TRUE;
5687 }
5688
5689 /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
5690
5691 static bfd_boolean
5692 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5693 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5694 {
5695 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5696 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
5697 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
5698 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5699 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5700 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5701 struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
5702 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
5703 bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
5704 file_ptr off;
5705 unsigned int count;
5706
5707 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5708 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5709 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5710 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
5711 {
5712 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5713
5714 hdr = *hdrpp;
5715 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5716 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
5717 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5718 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
5719 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
5720 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5721 {
5722 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
5723 _bfd_error_handler
5724 /* xgettext:c-format */
5725 (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
5726 abfd,
5727 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
5728 ? "*unknown*"
5729 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
5730 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
5731 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
5732 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5733 bed->maxpagesize);
5734 else
5735 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5736 hdr->sh_addralign);
5737 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
5738 FALSE);
5739 }
5740 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5741 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5742 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5743 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5744 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5745 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
5746 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5747 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5748 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
5749 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
5750 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5751 else
5752 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5753 }
5754
5755 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
5756 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
5757 count = 0;
5758 filehdr_vaddr = 0;
5759 filehdr_paddr = 0;
5760 phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5761 phdrs_paddr = 0;
5762 hdrs_segment = NULL;
5763 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5764 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5765 {
5766 ++count;
5767 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5768 continue;
5769
5770 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5771 {
5772 filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5773 filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5774 }
5775 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5776 {
5777 phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5778 phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5779 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5780 {
5781 hdrs_segment = m;
5782 phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5783 phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5784 }
5785 }
5786 }
5787
5788 if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
5789 {
5790 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5791 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5792 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5793
5794 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
5795 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
5796 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5797 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5798 if (hash != NULL
5799 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5800 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5801 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5802 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
5803 {
5804 asection *s = NULL;
5805 if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
5806 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5807 s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
5808 else
5809 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5810 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5811 if (m->count != 0)
5812 {
5813 s = m->sections[0];
5814 break;
5815 }
5816
5817 if (s != NULL)
5818 {
5819 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
5820 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
5821 }
5822 else
5823 {
5824 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
5825 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5826 }
5827
5828 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5829 hash->def_regular = 1;
5830 hash->non_elf = 0;
5831 }
5832 }
5833
5834 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5835 {
5836 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5837 {
5838 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
5839 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
5840
5841 if (link_info != NULL)
5842 {
5843 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
5844 in link_info. */
5845 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
5846 lm != NULL;
5847 lm = lm->next, lp++)
5848 {
5849 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5850 && lp->p_vaddr < link_info->relro_end
5851 && lm->count != 0
5852 && lm->sections[0]->vma >= link_info->relro_start)
5853 break;
5854 }
5855
5856 BFD_ASSERT (lm != NULL);
5857 }
5858 else
5859 {
5860 /* Otherwise we are copying an executable or shared
5861 library, but we need to use the same linker logic. */
5862 for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
5863 {
5864 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5865 && lp->p_paddr == p->p_paddr)
5866 break;
5867 }
5868 }
5869
5870 if (lp < phdrs + count)
5871 {
5872 p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
5873 p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
5874 p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
5875 if (link_info != NULL)
5876 p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
5877 else if (m->p_size_valid)
5878 p->p_filesz = m->p_size;
5879 else
5880 abort ();
5881 p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
5882 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are valid. The
5883 gold linker generates RW/4 for the PT_GNU_RELRO section.
5884 It is better for objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5885 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate debug files.
5886 */
5887 if (!m->p_align_valid)
5888 p->p_align = 1;
5889 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5890 p->p_flags = PF_R;
5891 }
5892 else
5893 {
5894 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5895 p->p_type = PT_NULL;
5896 }
5897 }
5898 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5899 {
5900 if (m->p_size_valid)
5901 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5902 }
5903 else if (m->count != 0)
5904 {
5905 unsigned int i;
5906
5907 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5908 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
5909 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
5910 {
5911 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
5912 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
5913 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
5914 {
5915 m->count = 0;
5916 continue;
5917 }
5918
5919 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
5920 {
5921 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
5922 _bfd_error_handler
5923 (_("%B: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
5924 "and/or program header"),
5925 abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
5926 return FALSE;
5927 }
5928
5929 p->p_filesz = 0;
5930 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
5931 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
5932 {
5933 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
5934 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
5935 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5936 {
5937 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
5938 + hdr->sh_size);
5939 break;
5940 }
5941 }
5942 }
5943 }
5944 else if (m->includes_filehdr)
5945 {
5946 p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
5947 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5948 p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
5949 }
5950 else if (m->includes_phdrs)
5951 {
5952 p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
5953 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5954 p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
5955 }
5956 }
5957
5958 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5959
5960 return TRUE;
5961 }
5962
5963 static elf_section_list *
5964 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
5965 {
5966 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
5967 if (list->ndx == i)
5968 break;
5969 return list;
5970 }
5971
5972 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
5973 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
5974 VMAs must be known before this is called.
5975
5976 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
5977 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
5978 those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
5979 stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
5980 consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
5981 image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
5982 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
5983
5984 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
5985
5986 static bfd_boolean
5987 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
5988 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5989 {
5990 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
5991 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5992 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5993
5994 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
5995 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5996 {
5997 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5998 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5999 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6000 unsigned int i;
6001 file_ptr off;
6002
6003 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6004 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6005
6006 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6007 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6008 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6009 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6010 {
6011 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6012
6013 hdr = *hdrpp;
6014 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6015 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6016 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6017 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
6018 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6019 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6020 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6021 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6022 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6023 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6024 {
6025 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6026 }
6027 else
6028 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6029 }
6030
6031 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6032 }
6033 else
6034 {
6035 unsigned int alloc;
6036
6037 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6038 assignment of sections to segments. */
6039 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6040 return FALSE;
6041
6042 /* And for non-load sections. */
6043 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6044 return FALSE;
6045
6046 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
6047 {
6048 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6049 return FALSE;
6050 }
6051
6052 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
6053 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6054 {
6055 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6056 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6057 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6058
6059 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6060 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6061 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6062 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6063 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6064
6065 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6066 segments is non-zero. */
6067 if (p_vaddr)
6068 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6069 }
6070
6071 /* Write out the program headers. */
6072 alloc = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
6073
6074 /* Sort the program headers into the ordering required by the ELF standard. */
6075 if (alloc == 0)
6076 return TRUE;
6077
6078 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if present, will
6079 be loaded into memory. FIXME: The check below is not sufficient as
6080 really all PT_LOAD segments should be checked before issuing an error
6081 message. Plus the PHDR segment does not have to be the first segment
6082 in the program header table. But this version of the check should
6083 catch all real world use cases.
6084
6085 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6086 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6087 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6088 changed or the programs updated. */
6089 if (alloc > 1
6090 && tdata->phdr[0].p_type == PT_PHDR
6091 && ! bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc)
6092 && tdata->phdr[1].p_type == PT_LOAD
6093 && (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr > tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr
6094 || (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[1].p_memsz)
6095 < (tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[0].p_memsz)))
6096 {
6097 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
6098 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
6099 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
6100 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
6101 %B: error: PHDR segment not covered by LOAD segment"),
6102 abfd);
6103 return FALSE;
6104 }
6105
6106 if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
6107 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6108 return FALSE;
6109 }
6110
6111 return TRUE;
6112 }
6113
6114 static bfd_boolean
6115 prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
6116 {
6117 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6118 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6119 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6120
6121 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6122
6123 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6124 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6125 return FALSE;
6126
6127 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6128
6129 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6130 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6131 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6132 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6133
6134 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6135 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6136 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6137 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6138
6139 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6140 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6141 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6142 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6143 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6144 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6145 else
6146 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6147
6148 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6149 {
6150 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6151 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6152 break;
6153
6154 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6155 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6156 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6157 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6158 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6159 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6160 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6161 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6162 default:
6163 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6164 }
6165
6166 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6167 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6168
6169 /* No program header, for now. */
6170 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6171 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6172 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6173
6174 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6175 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6176 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6177
6178 /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
6179 if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
6180 /* It all happens later. */
6181 ;
6182 else
6183 {
6184 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6185 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6186 }
6187
6188 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6189 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
6190 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6191 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
6192 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6193 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
6194 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6195 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6196 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6197 return FALSE;
6198
6199 return TRUE;
6200 }
6201
6202 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6203 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6204
6205 static bfd_boolean
6206 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6207 {
6208 file_ptr off;
6209 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6210 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6211 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6212 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6213
6214 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6215
6216 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6217 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6218 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6219 {
6220 shdrp = *shdrpp;
6221 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6222 {
6223 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6224 bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6225 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6226 if (is_rel
6227 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6228 {
6229 if (!is_rel)
6230 {
6231 const char *name = sec->name;
6232 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6233
6234 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6235 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6236 shdrp->contents))
6237 return FALSE;
6238
6239 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6240 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6241 {
6242 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6243 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6244 char *new_name
6245 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6246 if (new_name == NULL)
6247 return FALSE;
6248 name = new_name;
6249 }
6250 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6251 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6252 abort ();
6253 shdrp->sh_name
6254 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6255 name, FALSE);
6256 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6257
6258 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6259 if (d->rel.hdr
6260 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6261 d->rel.hdr,
6262 name, FALSE))
6263 return FALSE;
6264 if (d->rela.hdr
6265 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6266 d->rela.hdr,
6267 name, TRUE))
6268 return FALSE;
6269
6270 /* Update section size and contents. */
6271 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6272 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6273 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6274 }
6275 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6276 off,
6277 TRUE);
6278 }
6279 }
6280 }
6281
6282 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6283 compressed. */
6284 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6285 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6286 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6287 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
6288
6289 /* Place the section headers. */
6290 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6291 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6292 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6293 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6294 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6295 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6296
6297 return TRUE;
6298 }
6299
6300 bfd_boolean
6301 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6302 {
6303 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6304 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6305 bfd_boolean failed;
6306 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6307 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6308
6309 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6310 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6311 return FALSE;
6312
6313 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6314
6315 failed = FALSE;
6316 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6317 if (failed)
6318 return FALSE;
6319
6320 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6321 return FALSE;
6322
6323 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6324 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6325 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6326 {
6327 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6328 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6329 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6330 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6331 (*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]);
6332 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6333 {
6334 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6335
6336 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6337 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6338 return FALSE;
6339 }
6340 }
6341
6342 /* Write out the section header names. */
6343 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6344 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6345 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6346 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6347 return FALSE;
6348
6349 if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
6350 (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
6351
6352 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6353 return FALSE;
6354
6355 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6356 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6357 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6358
6359 return TRUE;
6360 }
6361
6362 bfd_boolean
6363 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6364 {
6365 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6366 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6367 }
6368
6369 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6370
6371 unsigned int
6372 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6373 {
6374 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6375 unsigned int sec_index;
6376
6377 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6378 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6379 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6380
6381 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6382 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6383 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6384 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6385 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6386 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6387 else
6388 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6389
6390 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6391 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6392 {
6393 int retval = sec_index;
6394
6395 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6396 return retval;
6397 }
6398
6399 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6400 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6401
6402 return sec_index;
6403 }
6404
6405 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6406 on error. */
6407
6408 int
6409 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6410 {
6411 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6412 int idx;
6413 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6414
6415 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6416 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6417 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6418 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6419 input sections rather than the output section. */
6420 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6421 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6422 && asym_ptr->section)
6423 {
6424 asection *sec;
6425 int indx;
6426
6427 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6428 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6429 sec = sec->output_section;
6430 if (sec->owner == abfd
6431 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6432 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6433 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6434 }
6435
6436 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6437
6438 if (idx == 0)
6439 {
6440 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6441 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6442 _bfd_error_handler
6443 /* xgettext:c-format */
6444 (_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6445 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6446 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6447 return -1;
6448 }
6449
6450 #if DEBUG & 4
6451 {
6452 fprintf (stderr,
6453 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6454 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6455 fflush (stderr);
6456 }
6457 #endif
6458
6459 return idx;
6460 }
6461
6462 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6463
6464 static bfd_boolean
6465 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6466 {
6467 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6468 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6469 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6470 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6471 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6472 asection *section;
6473 unsigned int i;
6474 unsigned int num_segments;
6475 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6476 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6477 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6478 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6479 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6480 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6481
6482 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6483 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6484
6485 map_first = NULL;
6486 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6487
6488 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6489 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6490
6491 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6492 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6493 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6494 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6495
6496 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6497 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6498 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6499 ? section->size : 0)
6500
6501 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6502 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6503 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
6504 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
6505 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6506 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6507
6508 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6509 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6510 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
6511 (section->lma >= base \
6512 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6513 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6514
6515 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6516 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6517 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6518 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6519 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6520 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6521 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6522
6523 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6524 etc. */
6525 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6526 (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
6527 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6528 && s->vma == 0 \
6529 && s->lma == 0)
6530
6531 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6532 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6533 p_memsz set to 0. */
6534 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6535 (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
6536 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6537 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6538 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6539 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6540 && s->size > 0 \
6541 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6542 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6543 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6544
6545 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6546 A section will be included if:
6547 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6548 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6549 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6550 segment.
6551 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6552 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6553 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6554 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6555 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6556 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6557 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6558 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6559 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6560 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6561 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6562 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6563 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6564 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6565 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6566 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6567 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6568 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6569 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6570 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6571 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6572 || (segment->p_paddr \
6573 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6574 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6575 || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
6576 == 0)) \
6577 && !section->segment_mark)
6578
6579 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6580 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6581 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6582 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6583 && section->output_section != NULL)
6584
6585 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6586 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6587 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6588
6589 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6590 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6591 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6592 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6593 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6594 LMA. */
6595 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6596 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6597 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6598 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6599 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6600
6601 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6602 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6603 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6604
6605 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6606 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6607 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6608 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6609 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6610 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6611 i < num_segments;
6612 i++, segment++)
6613 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6614 {
6615 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6616 break;
6617 }
6618
6619 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6620 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6621 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6622 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6623 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6624 i < num_segments;
6625 i++, segment++)
6626 {
6627 unsigned int j;
6628 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6629
6630 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6631 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6632 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6633 {
6634 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6635 assignment code will work. */
6636 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
6637 break;
6638 }
6639
6640 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6641 {
6642 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6643 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6644 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6645 continue;
6646 }
6647
6648 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6649 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6650 {
6651 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6652
6653 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6654 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6655 continue;
6656
6657 /* Merge the two segments together. */
6658 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
6659 {
6660 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6661 SEGMENT. */
6662 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
6663 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
6664
6665 if (extra_length > 0)
6666 {
6667 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
6668 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
6669 }
6670
6671 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6672
6673 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6674 i = 0;
6675 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6676 break;
6677 }
6678 else
6679 {
6680 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6681 SEGMENT2. */
6682 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
6683 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
6684
6685 if (extra_length > 0)
6686 {
6687 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
6688 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
6689 }
6690
6691 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
6692 }
6693 }
6694 }
6695
6696 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
6697 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6698 i < num_segments;
6699 i++, segment++)
6700 {
6701 unsigned int section_count;
6702 asection **sections;
6703 asection *output_section;
6704 unsigned int isec;
6705 bfd_vma matching_lma;
6706 bfd_vma suggested_lma;
6707 unsigned int j;
6708 bfd_size_type amt;
6709 asection *first_section;
6710 bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
6711 bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
6712
6713 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
6714 continue;
6715
6716 first_section = NULL;
6717 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
6718 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6719 section != NULL;
6720 section = section->next)
6721 {
6722 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
6723 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6724 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6725 {
6726 if (first_section == NULL)
6727 first_section = section;
6728 if (section->output_section != NULL)
6729 ++section_count;
6730 }
6731 }
6732
6733 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6734 all of the sections we have selected. */
6735 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6736 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6737 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6738 if (map == NULL)
6739 return FALSE;
6740
6741 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
6742 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
6743 map->next = NULL;
6744 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6745 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6746 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6747
6748 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
6749 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
6750 output segment. */
6751 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
6752 {
6753 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6754 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6755 }
6756
6757 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6758 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6759 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6760 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6761 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6762
6763 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6764 {
6765 map->includes_phdrs =
6766 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6767 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6768 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6769 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6770
6771 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6772 phdr_included = TRUE;
6773 }
6774
6775 if (section_count == 0)
6776 {
6777 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
6778 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
6779 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
6780 a warning is produced.
6781 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
6782 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
6783 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
6784 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6785 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
6786 /* xgettext:c-format */
6787 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: warning: Empty loadable segment detected"
6788 " at vaddr=%#Lx, is this intentional?"),
6789 ibfd, segment->p_vaddr);
6790
6791 map->count = 0;
6792 *pointer_to_map = map;
6793 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6794
6795 continue;
6796 }
6797
6798 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
6799 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
6800 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
6801 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
6802
6803 1. None of the sections have been moved.
6804 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
6805 input BFD.
6806
6807 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
6808 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6809 of the first section.
6810
6811 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
6812 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
6813 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
6814 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
6815 have to be created to contain the other sections.
6816
6817 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
6818 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6819 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
6820 or segments to contain the other sections.
6821
6822 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
6823 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
6824 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
6825
6826 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
6827 if (sections == NULL)
6828 return FALSE;
6829
6830 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
6831 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
6832 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
6833 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
6834 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
6835 more to do. */
6836 isec = 0;
6837 matching_lma = 0;
6838 suggested_lma = 0;
6839 first_matching_lma = TRUE;
6840 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
6841
6842 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
6843 section != NULL;
6844 section = section->next)
6845 {
6846 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6847 {
6848 output_section = section->output_section;
6849
6850 sections[j++] = section;
6851
6852 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
6853 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
6854 correct value. Note - some backends require that
6855 p_paddr be left as zero. */
6856 if (!p_paddr_valid
6857 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
6858 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6859 && isec == 0
6860 && output_section->lma != 0
6861 && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
6862 + (map->includes_filehdr
6863 ? iehdr->e_ehsize
6864 : 0)
6865 + (map->includes_phdrs
6866 ? (iehdr->e_phnum
6867 * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6868 : 0)))
6869 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6870
6871 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
6872 LMA address of the output section. */
6873 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6874 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
6875 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6876 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
6877 {
6878 if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
6879 {
6880 matching_lma = output_section->lma;
6881 first_matching_lma = FALSE;
6882 }
6883
6884 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
6885 then it does not overlap any other section within that
6886 segment. */
6887 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
6888 }
6889 else if (first_suggested_lma)
6890 {
6891 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6892 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6893 }
6894
6895 if (j == section_count)
6896 break;
6897 }
6898 }
6899
6900 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
6901
6902 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
6903 if necessary. */
6904 if (isec == section_count)
6905 {
6906 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
6907 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
6908 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
6909 program header in the input BFD. */
6910 map->count = section_count;
6911 *pointer_to_map = map;
6912 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6913
6914 if (p_paddr_valid
6915 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6916 && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
6917 && !map->includes_filehdr
6918 && !map->includes_phdrs)
6919 /* There is some padding before the first section in the
6920 segment. So, we must account for that in the output
6921 segment's vma. */
6922 map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
6923
6924 free (sections);
6925 continue;
6926 }
6927 else
6928 {
6929 if (!first_matching_lma)
6930 {
6931 /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
6932 Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
6933 LMA of the first section that fitted. */
6934 map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
6935 }
6936 else
6937 {
6938 /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
6939 Change the current segment's physical address to match
6940 the LMA of the first section. */
6941 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
6942 }
6943
6944 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
6945 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
6946 if (map->includes_filehdr)
6947 {
6948 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
6949 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
6950 else
6951 {
6952 map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
6953 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
6954 }
6955 }
6956
6957 if (map->includes_phdrs)
6958 {
6959 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6960 {
6961 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
6962
6963 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
6964 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
6965 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
6966 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
6967 offset when we know the correct value. */
6968 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
6969 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
6970 }
6971 else
6972 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
6973 }
6974 }
6975
6976 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
6977 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
6978 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
6979 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
6980 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
6981 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
6982 the loop. */
6983 isec = 0;
6984 do
6985 {
6986 map->count = 0;
6987 suggested_lma = 0;
6988 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
6989
6990 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
6991 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
6992 {
6993 section = sections[j];
6994
6995 if (section == NULL)
6996 continue;
6997
6998 output_section = section->output_section;
6999
7000 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7001
7002 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
7003 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7004 {
7005 if (map->count == 0)
7006 {
7007 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7008 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7009 wrong. */
7010 if (output_section->lma
7011 != (map->p_paddr
7012 + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7013 + (map->includes_phdrs
7014 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7015 : 0)))
7016 abort ();
7017 }
7018 else
7019 {
7020 asection *prev_sec;
7021
7022 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7023
7024 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7025 and the start of this section is more than
7026 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7027 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7028 maxpagesize)
7029 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7030 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7031 > output_section->lma))
7032 {
7033 if (first_suggested_lma)
7034 {
7035 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
7036 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
7037 }
7038
7039 continue;
7040 }
7041 }
7042
7043 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7044 ++isec;
7045 sections[j] = NULL;
7046 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
7047 }
7048 else if (first_suggested_lma)
7049 {
7050 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
7051 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
7052 }
7053 }
7054
7055 BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
7056
7057 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7058 *pointer_to_map = map;
7059 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7060
7061 if (isec < section_count)
7062 {
7063 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7064 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7065 and carry on looping. */
7066 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7067 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7068 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7069 if (map == NULL)
7070 {
7071 free (sections);
7072 return FALSE;
7073 }
7074
7075 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7076 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7077 not yet been assigned. */
7078 map->next = NULL;
7079 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7080 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7081 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7082 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
7083 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7084 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7085 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7086 }
7087 }
7088 while (isec < section_count);
7089
7090 free (sections);
7091 }
7092
7093 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7094
7095 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7096 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7097 the offset if necessary. */
7098 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7099 {
7100 unsigned int count;
7101
7102 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7103 count++;
7104
7105 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7106 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7107 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7108 }
7109
7110 #undef SEGMENT_END
7111 #undef SECTION_SIZE
7112 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7113 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7114 #undef IS_NOTE
7115 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7116 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7117 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7118 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7119 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7120 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7121 return TRUE;
7122 }
7123
7124 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7125
7126 static bfd_boolean
7127 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7128 {
7129 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7130 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7131 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7132 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7133 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7134 unsigned int i;
7135 unsigned int num_segments;
7136 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
7137 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
7138
7139 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7140
7141 map_first = NULL;
7142 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7143
7144 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7145 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7146 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7147 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7148 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7149 i < num_segments;
7150 i++, segment++)
7151 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7152 {
7153 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
7154 break;
7155 }
7156
7157 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7158 i < num_segments;
7159 i++, segment++)
7160 {
7161 asection *section;
7162 unsigned int section_count;
7163 bfd_size_type amt;
7164 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7165 asection *first_section = NULL;
7166 asection *lowest_section;
7167
7168 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7169 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7170 section != NULL;
7171 section = section->next)
7172 {
7173 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7174 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7175 {
7176 if (first_section == NULL)
7177 first_section = section;
7178 section_count++;
7179 }
7180 }
7181
7182 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7183 all of the sections we have selected. */
7184 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7185 if (section_count != 0)
7186 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7187 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7188 if (map == NULL)
7189 return FALSE;
7190
7191 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7192 input segment. */
7193 map->next = NULL;
7194 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7195 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7196 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7197 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7198 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7199 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7200 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7201 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7202
7203 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7204 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7205 {
7206 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7207 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7208 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7209 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7210 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7211 systems. */
7212 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7213 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7214 }
7215
7216 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7217 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7218 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7219 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7220
7221 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7222 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7223 {
7224 map->includes_phdrs =
7225 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7226 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7227 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7228 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7229
7230 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7231 phdr_included = TRUE;
7232 }
7233
7234 lowest_section = NULL;
7235 if (section_count != 0)
7236 {
7237 unsigned int isec = 0;
7238
7239 for (section = first_section;
7240 section != NULL;
7241 section = section->next)
7242 {
7243 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7244 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7245 {
7246 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7247 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7248 {
7249 bfd_vma seg_off;
7250
7251 if (lowest_section == NULL
7252 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7253 lowest_section = section;
7254
7255 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7256 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7257 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7258 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7259 invalid. */
7260 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7261 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7262 else
7263 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7264 if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7265 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7266 }
7267 if (isec == section_count)
7268 break;
7269 }
7270 }
7271 }
7272
7273 if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
7274 /* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed. */
7275 map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
7276
7277 if (!map->includes_phdrs
7278 && !map->includes_filehdr
7279 && map->p_paddr_valid)
7280 /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
7281 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
7282 - segment->p_paddr);
7283
7284 map->count = section_count;
7285 *pointer_to_map = map;
7286 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7287 }
7288
7289 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7290 return TRUE;
7291 }
7292
7293 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7294 information. */
7295
7296 static bfd_boolean
7297 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7298 {
7299 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7300 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7301 return TRUE;
7302
7303 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7304 return TRUE;
7305
7306 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7307 {
7308 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7309 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7310 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7311 asection *section, *osec;
7312 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7313 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7314 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7315
7316 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7317
7318 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7319 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7320 goto rewrite;
7321
7322 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7323 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7324 section = section->next)
7325 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7326
7327 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7328 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7329 i < num_segments;
7330 i++, segment++)
7331 {
7332 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7333 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7334 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7335 map in this case. */
7336 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7337 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7338 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7339 goto rewrite;
7340
7341 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7342 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7343 {
7344 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7345 from the input BFD. */
7346 osec = section->output_section;
7347 if (osec)
7348 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
7349
7350 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7351 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7352 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7353 {
7354 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7355 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7356 if (osec == NULL
7357 || section->flags != osec->flags
7358 || section->lma != osec->lma
7359 || section->vma != osec->vma
7360 || section->size != osec->size
7361 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7362 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7363 goto rewrite;
7364 }
7365 }
7366 }
7367
7368 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7369 input BFD. */
7370 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7371 section = section->next)
7372 {
7373 if (!section->segment_mark)
7374 goto rewrite;
7375 else
7376 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7377 }
7378
7379 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7380 }
7381
7382 rewrite:
7383 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7384 {
7385 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7386 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7387 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7388 unsigned int i;
7389 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7390 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
7391
7392 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7393 i < num_segments;
7394 i++, segment++)
7395 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7396 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7397 {
7398 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7399 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7400 /* xgettext:c-format */
7401 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: warning: segment alignment of %#Lx"
7402 " is too large"),
7403 ibfd, segment->p_align);
7404 else
7405 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7406 }
7407
7408 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
7409 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
7410 }
7411
7412 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7413 }
7414
7415 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7416
7417 bfd_boolean
7418 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7419 asection *isec,
7420 bfd *obfd,
7421 asection *osec,
7422 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7423
7424 {
7425 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7426 bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
7427 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7428
7429 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7430 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7431 return TRUE;
7432
7433 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7434
7435 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
7436 section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
7437 set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
7438 that the linker clears to differ. */
7439 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7440 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7441 || (final_link
7442 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7443 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7444 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7445
7446 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7447 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7448 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7449
7450 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7451 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7452 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7453 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7454
7455 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7456 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7457 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7458 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7459 if ((link_info == NULL
7460 || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7461 && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7462 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7463 {
7464 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7465 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7466 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7467 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7468 }
7469
7470 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7471 if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7472 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7473 & SHF_COMPRESSED);
7474
7475 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7476
7477 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7478 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7479 may be NULL at this point. */
7480 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7481 {
7482 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7483 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7484 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7485 }
7486
7487 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7488
7489 return TRUE;
7490 }
7491
7492 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7493 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7494
7495 bfd_boolean
7496 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7497 asection *isec,
7498 bfd *obfd,
7499 asection *osec)
7500 {
7501 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7502
7503 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7504 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7505 return TRUE;
7506
7507 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7508 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7509
7510 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7511
7512 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7513 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7514 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7515 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7516 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7517
7518 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7519 NULL);
7520 }
7521
7522 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7523 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7524 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7525 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7526 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7527 from the linker. */
7528
7529 bfd_boolean
7530 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7531 {
7532 asection *isec;
7533
7534 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7535 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7536 {
7537 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7538 asection *s = first;
7539 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7540
7541 while (s != NULL)
7542 {
7543 /* If this member section is being output but the
7544 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7545 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7546 if (s->output_section != discarded
7547 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7548 {
7549 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7550 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7551 }
7552 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7553 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7554 else if (s->output_section == discarded
7555 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7556 removed += 4;
7557 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7558 if (s == first)
7559 break;
7560 }
7561 if (removed != 0)
7562 {
7563 if (discarded != NULL)
7564 {
7565 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7566 adjust the input section size. This function may
7567 be called multiple times, so save the original
7568 size. */
7569 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7570 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7571 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7572 }
7573 else
7574 {
7575 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7576 objcopy. */
7577 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7578 }
7579 }
7580 }
7581
7582 return TRUE;
7583 }
7584
7585 /* Copy private header information. */
7586
7587 bfd_boolean
7588 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7589 {
7590 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7591 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7592 return TRUE;
7593
7594 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7595 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7596 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7597 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7598 already been worked out. */
7599 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7600 {
7601 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7602 return FALSE;
7603 }
7604
7605 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
7606 }
7607
7608 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7609 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7610 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7611 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7612 swap_out_syms function. */
7613
7614 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7615 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7616 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7617 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7618 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7619
7620 bfd_boolean
7621 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
7622 asymbol *isymarg,
7623 bfd *obfd,
7624 asymbol *osymarg)
7625 {
7626 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
7627
7628 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7629 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7630 return TRUE;
7631
7632 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
7633 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
7634
7635 if (isym != NULL
7636 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
7637 && osym != NULL
7638 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
7639 {
7640 unsigned int shndx;
7641
7642 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7643 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
7644 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
7645 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
7646 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
7647 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
7648 shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
7649 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
7650 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
7651 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
7652 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
7653 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7654 }
7655
7656 return TRUE;
7657 }
7658
7659 /* Swap out the symbols. */
7660
7661 static bfd_boolean
7662 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
7663 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
7664 int relocatable_p)
7665 {
7666 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7667 int symcount;
7668 asymbol **syms;
7669 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
7670 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7671 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
7672 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
7673 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
7674 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
7675 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
7676 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
7677 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
7678 int idx;
7679 unsigned int num_locals;
7680 bfd_size_type amt;
7681 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
7682
7683 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
7684 return FALSE;
7685
7686 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
7687 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
7688 if (stt == NULL)
7689 return FALSE;
7690
7691 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7692 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
7693 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7694 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
7695 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
7696 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
7697 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
7698 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
7699
7700 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
7701 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7702
7703 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
7704 symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
7705 * sizeof (*symstrtab));
7706 if (symstrtab == NULL)
7707 {
7708 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7709 return FALSE;
7710 }
7711
7712 outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
7713 bed->s->sizeof_sym);
7714 if (outbound_syms == NULL)
7715 {
7716 error_return:
7717 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7718 free (symstrtab);
7719 return FALSE;
7720 }
7721 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
7722 outbound_syms_index = 0;
7723
7724 outbound_shndx = NULL;
7725 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
7726
7727 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7728 {
7729 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
7730 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
7731 {
7732 amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7733 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
7734 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
7735 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
7736 goto error_return;
7737
7738 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
7739 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
7740 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
7741 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7742 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7743 }
7744 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
7745 }
7746
7747 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
7748 {
7749 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
7750 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7751 sym.st_name = 0;
7752 sym.st_value = 0;
7753 sym.st_size = 0;
7754 sym.st_info = 0;
7755 sym.st_other = 0;
7756 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7757 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7758 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
7759 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7760 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7761 outbound_syms_index++;
7762 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7763 outbound_shndx_index++;
7764 }
7765
7766 name_local_sections
7767 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
7768 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
7769
7770 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
7771 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
7772 {
7773 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7774 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
7775 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
7776 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
7777 int type;
7778
7779 if (!name_local_sections
7780 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7781 {
7782 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
7783 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
7784 }
7785 else
7786 {
7787 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
7788 to get the final offset for st_name. */
7789 sym.st_name
7790 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
7791 FALSE);
7792 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7793 goto error_return;
7794 }
7795
7796 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
7797
7798 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
7799 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7800 {
7801 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
7802 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
7803 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
7804 sym.st_size = value;
7805 if (type_ptr == NULL
7806 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
7807 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
7808 else
7809 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
7810 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
7811 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
7812 }
7813 else
7814 {
7815 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
7816 unsigned int shndx;
7817
7818 if (sec->output_section)
7819 {
7820 value += sec->output_offset;
7821 sec = sec->output_section;
7822 }
7823
7824 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
7825 if (! relocatable_p)
7826 value += sec->vma;
7827 sym.st_value = value;
7828 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
7829
7830 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
7831 && type_ptr != NULL
7832 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
7833 {
7834 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
7835 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
7836 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
7837 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7838 switch (shndx)
7839 {
7840 case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
7841 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
7842 break;
7843 case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
7844 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
7845 break;
7846 case MAP_STRTAB:
7847 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
7848 break;
7849 case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
7850 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
7851 break;
7852 case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
7853 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7854 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
7855 break;
7856 default:
7857 shndx = SHN_ABS;
7858 break;
7859 }
7860 }
7861 else
7862 {
7863 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
7864
7865 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7866 {
7867 asection *sec2;
7868
7869 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
7870 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
7871 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
7872 demand of applications. For example, it
7873 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
7874 section of a symbol to be a section that is
7875 actually in the output file. */
7876 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
7877 if (sec2 != NULL)
7878 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
7879 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7880 {
7881 /* xgettext:c-format */
7882 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
7883 Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
7884 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
7885 sec->name);
7886 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7887 goto error_return;
7888 }
7889 }
7890 }
7891
7892 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7893 }
7894
7895 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
7896 type = STT_TLS;
7897 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
7898 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
7899 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
7900 type = STT_FUNC;
7901 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
7902 type = STT_OBJECT;
7903 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
7904 type = STT_RELC;
7905 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
7906 type = STT_SRELC;
7907 else
7908 type = STT_NOTYPE;
7909
7910 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
7911 type = STT_TLS;
7912
7913 /* Processor-specific types. */
7914 if (type_ptr != NULL
7915 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
7916 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
7917 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
7918
7919 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7920 {
7921 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
7922 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7923 else
7924 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
7925 }
7926 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7927 {
7928 if (type != STT_TLS)
7929 {
7930 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
7931 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
7932 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
7933 else
7934 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
7935 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
7936 }
7937 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
7938 }
7939 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
7940 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
7941 ? STB_WEAK
7942 : STB_GLOBAL),
7943 type);
7944 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
7945 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
7946 else
7947 {
7948 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
7949
7950 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
7951 bind = STB_LOCAL;
7952 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
7953 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
7954 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
7955 bind = STB_WEAK;
7956 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
7957 bind = STB_GLOBAL;
7958
7959 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
7960 }
7961
7962 if (type_ptr != NULL)
7963 {
7964 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
7965 sym.st_target_internal
7966 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
7967 }
7968 else
7969 {
7970 sym.st_other = 0;
7971 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7972 }
7973
7974 idx++;
7975 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
7976 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7977 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7978
7979 outbound_syms_index++;
7980 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7981 outbound_shndx_index++;
7982 }
7983
7984 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
7985 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
7986
7987 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
7988 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
7989 {
7990 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
7991 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7992 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
7993 else
7994 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
7995 elfsym->sym.st_name);
7996 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
7997 (outbound_syms
7998 + (elfsym->dest_index
7999 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8000 (outbound_shndx
8001 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8002 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8003 }
8004 free (symstrtab);
8005
8006 *sttp = stt;
8007 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8008 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8009 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8010 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8011 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8012 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8013 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8014 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8015
8016 return TRUE;
8017 }
8018
8019 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8020
8021 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8022 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8023 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8024
8025 long
8026 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8027 {
8028 long symcount;
8029 long symtab_size;
8030 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8031
8032 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8033 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8034 if (symcount > 0)
8035 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8036
8037 return symtab_size;
8038 }
8039
8040 long
8041 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8042 {
8043 long symcount;
8044 long symtab_size;
8045 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8046
8047 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8048 {
8049 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8050 return -1;
8051 }
8052
8053 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8054 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8055 if (symcount > 0)
8056 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8057
8058 return symtab_size;
8059 }
8060
8061 long
8062 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8063 sec_ptr asect)
8064 {
8065 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8066 }
8067
8068 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8069
8070 long
8071 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8072 sec_ptr section,
8073 arelent **relptr,
8074 asymbol **symbols)
8075 {
8076 arelent *tblptr;
8077 unsigned int i;
8078 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8079
8080 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
8081 return -1;
8082
8083 tblptr = section->relocation;
8084 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8085 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8086
8087 *relptr = NULL;
8088
8089 return section->reloc_count;
8090 }
8091
8092 long
8093 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8094 {
8095 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8096 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
8097
8098 if (symcount >= 0)
8099 bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8100 return symcount;
8101 }
8102
8103 long
8104 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8105 asymbol **allocation)
8106 {
8107 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8108 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
8109
8110 if (symcount >= 0)
8111 bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8112 return symcount;
8113 }
8114
8115 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8116 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8117 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8118 dynamic reloc section. */
8119
8120 long
8121 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8122 {
8123 long ret;
8124 asection *s;
8125
8126 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8127 {
8128 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8129 return -1;
8130 }
8131
8132 ret = sizeof (arelent *);
8133 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8134 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8135 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8136 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8137 ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
8138 * sizeof (arelent *));
8139
8140 return ret;
8141 }
8142
8143 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8144 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8145 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8146 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8147 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8148 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8149 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8150
8151 long
8152 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8153 arelent **storage,
8154 asymbol **syms)
8155 {
8156 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8157 asection *s;
8158 long ret;
8159
8160 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8161 {
8162 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8163 return -1;
8164 }
8165
8166 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8167 ret = 0;
8168 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8169 {
8170 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8171 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8172 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8173 {
8174 arelent *p;
8175 long count, i;
8176
8177 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
8178 return -1;
8179 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8180 p = s->relocation;
8181 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8182 *storage++ = p++;
8183 ret += count;
8184 }
8185 }
8186
8187 *storage = NULL;
8188
8189 return ret;
8190 }
8191 \f
8192 /* Read in the version information. */
8193
8194 bfd_boolean
8195 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
8196 {
8197 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8198 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8199
8200 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8201 {
8202 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8203 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8204 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8205 unsigned int i;
8206 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8207
8208 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8209
8210 if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8211 || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8212 {
8213 error_return_bad_verref:
8214 _bfd_error_handler
8215 (_("%B: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8216 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8217 error_return_verref:
8218 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8219 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8220 goto error_return;
8221 }
8222
8223 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8224 if (contents == NULL)
8225 goto error_return_verref;
8226
8227 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8228 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8229 goto error_return_verref;
8230
8231 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
8232 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
8233
8234 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8235 goto error_return_verref;
8236
8237 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8238 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8239 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8240 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8241 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8242 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8243 {
8244 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8245 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8246 unsigned int j;
8247
8248 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8249
8250 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8251
8252 iverneed->vn_filename =
8253 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8254 iverneed->vn_file);
8255 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8256 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8257
8258 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8259 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8260 else
8261 {
8262 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8263 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
8264 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
8265 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8266 goto error_return_verref;
8267 }
8268
8269 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8270 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8271 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8272
8273 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8274 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8275 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8276 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8277 {
8278 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8279
8280 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8281 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8282 ivernaux->vna_name);
8283 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8284 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8285
8286 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8287 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8288
8289 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8290 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8291 {
8292 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8293 break;
8294 }
8295 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8296 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8297
8298 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8299 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8300 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8301
8302 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8303 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8304 }
8305
8306 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8307 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8308 break;
8309 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8310 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8311
8312 if (iverneed->vn_next
8313 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8314 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8315
8316 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8317 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8318 }
8319 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8320
8321 free (contents);
8322 contents = NULL;
8323 }
8324
8325 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8326 {
8327 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8328 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8329 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8330 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8331 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8332 unsigned int i;
8333 unsigned int maxidx;
8334 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8335
8336 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8337
8338 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8339 {
8340 error_return_bad_verdef:
8341 _bfd_error_handler
8342 (_("%B: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8343 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8344 error_return_verdef:
8345 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8346 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8347 goto error_return;
8348 }
8349
8350 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8351 if (contents == NULL)
8352 goto error_return_verdef;
8353 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8354 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8355 goto error_return_verdef;
8356
8357 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8358 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8359 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8360 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8361 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8362 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8363
8364 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8365 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8366 the maximum. */
8367 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8368 maxidx = 0;
8369 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8370 {
8371 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8372
8373 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8374 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8375 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8376 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8377
8378 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8379 break;
8380
8381 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8382 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8383 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8384
8385 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8386 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8387 }
8388
8389 if (default_imported_symver)
8390 {
8391 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8392 maxidx = ++freeidx;
8393 else
8394 freeidx = ++maxidx;
8395 }
8396
8397 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8398 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8399 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8400 goto error_return_verdef;
8401
8402 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8403
8404 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8405 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8406 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8407 {
8408 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8409 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8410 unsigned int j;
8411
8412 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8413
8414 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8415 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8416
8417 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8418 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8419
8420 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8421
8422 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8423 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8424 else
8425 {
8426 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8427 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
8428 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
8429 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8430 goto error_return_verdef;
8431 }
8432
8433 if (iverdef->vd_aux
8434 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8435 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8436
8437 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8438 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8439 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8440 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8441 {
8442 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8443
8444 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8445 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8446 iverdaux->vda_name);
8447 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8448 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8449
8450 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8451 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8452 {
8453 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8454 break;
8455 }
8456 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8457 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8458
8459 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8460 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8461 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8462
8463 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8464 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8465 }
8466
8467 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8468 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8469 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8470
8471 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8472 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8473 break;
8474 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8475 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8476
8477 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8478 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8479 }
8480
8481 free (contents);
8482 contents = NULL;
8483 }
8484 else if (default_imported_symver)
8485 {
8486 if (freeidx < 3)
8487 freeidx = 3;
8488 else
8489 freeidx++;
8490
8491 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8492 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8493 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8494 goto error_return;
8495
8496 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
8497 }
8498
8499 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8500 if (default_imported_symver)
8501 {
8502 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8503 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8504
8505 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
8506
8507 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
8508 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
8509 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
8510 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
8511
8512 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8513
8514 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
8515 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
8516 goto error_return_verdef;
8517 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8518 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8519 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
8520 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8521 goto error_return_verdef;
8522
8523 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8524 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
8525 }
8526
8527 return TRUE;
8528
8529 error_return:
8530 if (contents != NULL)
8531 free (contents);
8532 return FALSE;
8533 }
8534 \f
8535 asymbol *
8536 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
8537 {
8538 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
8539
8540 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
8541 if (!newsym)
8542 return NULL;
8543 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
8544 return &newsym->symbol;
8545 }
8546
8547 void
8548 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8549 asymbol *symbol,
8550 symbol_info *ret)
8551 {
8552 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
8553 }
8554
8555 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8556 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8557 override it. */
8558
8559 bfd_boolean
8560 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8561 const char *name)
8562 {
8563 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8564 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
8565 return TRUE;
8566
8567 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8568 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8569 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
8570 return TRUE;
8571
8572 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8573 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8574 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8575 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8576 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8577 we treat such symbols as local. */
8578 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
8579 return TRUE;
8580
8581 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8582 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8583 These labels have the form:
8584
8585 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8586
8587 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8588
8589 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8590 so we only need to match the rest. */
8591 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
8592 {
8593 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8594 const char * p;
8595 char c;
8596
8597 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
8598 {
8599 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
8600 {
8601 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
8602 /* A fake symbol. */
8603 return TRUE;
8604
8605 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8606 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8607 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8608 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8609 other than some kind of local ? */
8610 ret = TRUE;
8611 }
8612
8613 if (! ISDIGIT (c))
8614 {
8615 ret = FALSE;
8616 break;
8617 }
8618 }
8619 return ret;
8620 }
8621
8622 return FALSE;
8623 }
8624
8625 alent *
8626 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8627 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8628 {
8629 abort ();
8630 return NULL;
8631 }
8632
8633 bfd_boolean
8634 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
8635 enum bfd_architecture arch,
8636 unsigned long machine)
8637 {
8638 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
8639 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
8640 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
8641 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
8642 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
8643 return FALSE;
8644
8645 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
8646 }
8647
8648 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
8649 for error reporting. */
8650
8651 bfd_boolean
8652 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
8653 asymbol **symbols,
8654 asection *section,
8655 bfd_vma offset,
8656 const char **filename_ptr,
8657 const char **functionname_ptr,
8658 unsigned int *line_ptr,
8659 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
8660 {
8661 bfd_boolean found;
8662
8663 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
8664 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8665 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
8666 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8667 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
8668 || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8669 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8670 line_ptr))
8671 {
8672 if (!*functionname_ptr)
8673 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8674 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
8675 functionname_ptr);
8676 return TRUE;
8677 }
8678
8679 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8680 &found, filename_ptr,
8681 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8682 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
8683 return FALSE;
8684 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
8685 return TRUE;
8686
8687 if (symbols == NULL)
8688 return FALSE;
8689
8690 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8691 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
8692 return FALSE;
8693
8694 *line_ptr = 0;
8695 return TRUE;
8696 }
8697
8698 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
8699
8700 bfd_boolean
8701 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
8702 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
8703 {
8704 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
8705 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
8706 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8707 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8708 }
8709
8710 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
8711 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
8712 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
8713 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
8714 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
8715
8716 bfd_boolean
8717 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8718 const char **filename_ptr,
8719 const char **functionname_ptr,
8720 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8721 {
8722 bfd_boolean found;
8723 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8724 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8725 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8726 return found;
8727 }
8728
8729 int
8730 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8731 {
8732 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8733 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
8734
8735 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8736 {
8737 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
8738
8739 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
8740 {
8741 struct elf_segment_map *m;
8742
8743 phdr_size = 0;
8744 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
8745 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
8746
8747 if (phdr_size == 0)
8748 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
8749 }
8750
8751 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
8752 ret += phdr_size;
8753 }
8754
8755 return ret;
8756 }
8757
8758 bfd_boolean
8759 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
8760 sec_ptr section,
8761 const void *location,
8762 file_ptr offset,
8763 bfd_size_type count)
8764 {
8765 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8766 file_ptr pos;
8767
8768 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
8769 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
8770 return FALSE;
8771
8772 if (!count)
8773 return TRUE;
8774
8775 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
8776 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
8777 {
8778 /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
8779 unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
8780 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
8781 || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
8782 || contents == NULL)
8783 abort ();
8784 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
8785 return TRUE;
8786 }
8787 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
8788 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
8789 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
8790 return FALSE;
8791
8792 return TRUE;
8793 }
8794
8795 void
8796 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8797 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8798 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8799 {
8800 abort ();
8801 }
8802
8803 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
8804
8805 bfd_boolean
8806 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
8807 {
8808 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
8809
8810 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
8811 {
8812 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
8813 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8814
8815 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
8816 equivalent ELF reloc. */
8817
8818 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
8819 {
8820 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8821 {
8822 case 8:
8823 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
8824 break;
8825 case 12:
8826 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
8827 break;
8828 case 16:
8829 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
8830 break;
8831 case 24:
8832 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
8833 break;
8834 case 32:
8835 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
8836 break;
8837 case 64:
8838 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
8839 break;
8840 default:
8841 goto fail;
8842 }
8843
8844 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8845
8846 if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
8847 {
8848 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
8849 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
8850 else
8851 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
8852 }
8853 }
8854 else
8855 {
8856 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8857 {
8858 case 8:
8859 code = BFD_RELOC_8;
8860 break;
8861 case 14:
8862 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
8863 break;
8864 case 16:
8865 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
8866 break;
8867 case 26:
8868 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
8869 break;
8870 case 32:
8871 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
8872 break;
8873 case 64:
8874 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
8875 break;
8876 default:
8877 goto fail;
8878 }
8879
8880 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8881 }
8882
8883 if (howto)
8884 areloc->howto = howto;
8885 else
8886 goto fail;
8887 }
8888
8889 return TRUE;
8890
8891 fail:
8892 _bfd_error_handler
8893 /* xgettext:c-format */
8894 (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
8895 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
8896 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8897 return FALSE;
8898 }
8899
8900 bfd_boolean
8901 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
8902 {
8903 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
8904 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
8905 {
8906 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
8907 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
8908 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8909 }
8910
8911 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
8912 }
8913
8914 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
8915 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
8916 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
8917 this reloc. */
8918
8919 bfd_reloc_status_type
8920 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
8921 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8922 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8923 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8924 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8925 {
8926 return bfd_reloc_ok;
8927 }
8928 \f
8929 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
8930 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
8931 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
8932 out details about the corefile. */
8933
8934 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
8935 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
8936 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
8937 # include <sys/procfs.h>
8938 #endif
8939
8940 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
8941 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
8942
8943 static int
8944 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
8945 {
8946 int pid;
8947
8948 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
8949 if (pid == 0)
8950 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
8951
8952 return pid;
8953 }
8954
8955 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
8956 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
8957 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
8958 overwrite it. */
8959
8960 static bfd_boolean
8961 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
8962 {
8963 asection *sect2;
8964
8965 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
8966 return TRUE;
8967
8968 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
8969 if (sect2 == NULL)
8970 return FALSE;
8971
8972 sect2->size = sect->size;
8973 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
8974 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
8975 return TRUE;
8976 }
8977
8978 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
8979 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
8980 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
8981 such a section already exists.
8982 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
8983 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
8984 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
8985 bfd_boolean
8986 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
8987 char *name,
8988 size_t size,
8989 ufile_ptr filepos)
8990 {
8991 char buf[100];
8992 char *threaded_name;
8993 size_t len;
8994 asection *sect;
8995
8996 /* Build the section name. */
8997
8998 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8999 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9000 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9001 if (threaded_name == NULL)
9002 return FALSE;
9003 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9004
9005 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9006 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9007 if (sect == NULL)
9008 return FALSE;
9009 sect->size = size;
9010 sect->filepos = filepos;
9011 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9012
9013 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9014 }
9015
9016 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9017 solaris 2.5+
9018 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9019 unixware 4.2
9020 */
9021
9022 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9023
9024 static bfd_boolean
9025 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9026 {
9027 size_t size;
9028 int offset;
9029
9030 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9031 {
9032 prstatus_t prstat;
9033
9034 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9035 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9036 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9037
9038 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9039 has already been set by another thread. */
9040 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9041 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9042 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9043 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9044
9045 /* pr_who exists on:
9046 solaris 2.5+
9047 unixware 4.2
9048 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9049 linux 2.[01]
9050 */
9051 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9052 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9053 #else
9054 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9055 #endif
9056 }
9057 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9058 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9059 {
9060 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9061 prstatus32_t prstat;
9062
9063 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9064 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9065 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9066
9067 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9068 has already been set by another thread. */
9069 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9070 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9071 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9072 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9073
9074 /* pr_who exists on:
9075 solaris 2.5+
9076 unixware 4.2
9077 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9078 linux 2.[01]
9079 */
9080 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9081 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9082 #else
9083 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9084 #endif
9085 }
9086 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9087 else
9088 {
9089 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9090 note size (ie. data object type). */
9091 return TRUE;
9092 }
9093
9094 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9095 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9096 size, note->descpos + offset);
9097 }
9098 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9099
9100 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9101 static bfd_boolean
9102 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9103 char *name,
9104 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9105 {
9106 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9107 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9108 }
9109
9110 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9111 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9112 data structure apart. */
9113
9114 static bfd_boolean
9115 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9116 {
9117 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9118 }
9119
9120 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9121 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9122 literally. */
9123
9124 static bfd_boolean
9125 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9126 {
9127 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9128 }
9129
9130 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9131 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9132 contents literally. */
9133
9134 static bfd_boolean
9135 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9136 {
9137 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9138 }
9139
9140 static bfd_boolean
9141 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9142 {
9143 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9144 }
9145
9146 static bfd_boolean
9147 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9148 {
9149 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9150 }
9151
9152 static bfd_boolean
9153 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9154 {
9155 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9156 }
9157
9158 static bfd_boolean
9159 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9160 {
9161 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9162 }
9163
9164 static bfd_boolean
9165 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9166 {
9167 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9168 }
9169
9170 static bfd_boolean
9171 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9172 {
9173 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9174 }
9175
9176 static bfd_boolean
9177 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9178 {
9179 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9180 }
9181
9182 static bfd_boolean
9183 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9184 {
9185 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9186 }
9187
9188 static bfd_boolean
9189 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9190 {
9191 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9192 }
9193
9194 static bfd_boolean
9195 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9196 {
9197 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9198 }
9199
9200 static bfd_boolean
9201 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9202 {
9203 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9204 }
9205
9206 static bfd_boolean
9207 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9208 {
9209 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9210 }
9211
9212 static bfd_boolean
9213 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9214 {
9215 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9216 }
9217
9218 static bfd_boolean
9219 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9220 {
9221 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9222 }
9223
9224 static bfd_boolean
9225 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9226 {
9227 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9228 }
9229
9230 static bfd_boolean
9231 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9232 {
9233 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9234 }
9235
9236 static bfd_boolean
9237 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9238 {
9239 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9240 }
9241
9242 static bfd_boolean
9243 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9244 {
9245 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9246 }
9247
9248 static bfd_boolean
9249 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9250 {
9251 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9252 }
9253
9254 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9255 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9256 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9257 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9258 #endif
9259 #endif
9260
9261 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9262 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9263 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9264 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9265 #endif
9266 #endif
9267
9268 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9269 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9270 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9271
9272 char *
9273 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9274 {
9275 char *dups;
9276 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9277 size_t len;
9278
9279 if (end == NULL)
9280 len = max;
9281 else
9282 len = end - start;
9283
9284 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9285 if (dups == NULL)
9286 return NULL;
9287
9288 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9289 dups[len] = '\0';
9290
9291 return dups;
9292 }
9293
9294 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9295 static bfd_boolean
9296 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9297 {
9298 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9299 {
9300 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9301
9302 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9303
9304 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9305 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9306 #endif
9307 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9308 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9309 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9310
9311 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9312 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9313 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9314 }
9315 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9316 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
9317 {
9318 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9319 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
9320
9321 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9322
9323 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9324 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9325 #endif
9326 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9327 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9328 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9329
9330 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9331 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9332 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9333 }
9334 #endif
9335
9336 else
9337 {
9338 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9339 note size (ie. data object type). */
9340 return TRUE;
9341 }
9342
9343 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9344 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9345 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9346
9347 {
9348 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
9349 int n = strlen (command);
9350
9351 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
9352 command[n - 1] = '\0';
9353 }
9354
9355 return TRUE;
9356 }
9357 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
9358
9359 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9360 static bfd_boolean
9361 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9362 {
9363 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
9364 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
9365 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
9366 #endif
9367 )
9368 {
9369 pstatus_t pstat;
9370
9371 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9372
9373 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9374 }
9375 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9376 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
9377 {
9378 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9379 pstatus32_t pstat;
9380
9381 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9382
9383 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9384 }
9385 #endif
9386 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
9387 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
9388 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
9389
9390 return TRUE;
9391 }
9392 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
9393
9394 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9395 static bfd_boolean
9396 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9397 {
9398 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9399 char buf[100];
9400 char *name;
9401 size_t len;
9402 asection *sect;
9403
9404 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
9405 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
9406 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
9407 #endif
9408 )
9409 return TRUE;
9410
9411 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
9412
9413 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
9414 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
9415 another thread. */
9416 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9417 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
9418
9419 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9420
9421 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9422 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9423 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9424 if (name == NULL)
9425 return FALSE;
9426 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9427
9428 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9429 if (sect == NULL)
9430 return FALSE;
9431
9432 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9433 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9434 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9435 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9436 #endif
9437
9438 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9439 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
9440 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
9441 #endif
9442
9443 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9444
9445 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9446 return FALSE;
9447
9448 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
9449
9450 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9451 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9452 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9453 if (name == NULL)
9454 return FALSE;
9455 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9456
9457 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9458 if (sect == NULL)
9459 return FALSE;
9460
9461 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9462 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9463 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9464 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9465 #endif
9466
9467 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
9468 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
9469 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
9470 #endif
9471
9472 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9473
9474 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
9475 }
9476 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
9477
9478 static bfd_boolean
9479 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9480 {
9481 char buf[30];
9482 char *name;
9483 size_t len;
9484 asection *sect;
9485 int type;
9486 int is_active_thread;
9487 bfd_vma base_addr;
9488
9489 if (note->descsz < 728)
9490 return TRUE;
9491
9492 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
9493 return TRUE;
9494
9495 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
9496
9497 switch (type)
9498 {
9499 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
9500 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
9501 /* process_info.pid */
9502 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9503 /* process_info.signal */
9504 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
9505 break;
9506
9507 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
9508 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9509 /* thread_info.tid */
9510 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
9511
9512 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9513 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9514 if (name == NULL)
9515 return FALSE;
9516
9517 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9518
9519 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9520 if (sect == NULL)
9521 return FALSE;
9522
9523 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9524 sect->size = 716;
9525 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9526 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
9527 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9528
9529 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
9530 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9531
9532 if (is_active_thread)
9533 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9534 return FALSE;
9535 break;
9536
9537 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
9538 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
9539 /* module_info.base_address */
9540 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
9541 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
9542
9543 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9544 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9545 if (name == NULL)
9546 return FALSE;
9547
9548 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9549
9550 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9551
9552 if (sect == NULL)
9553 return FALSE;
9554
9555 sect->size = note->descsz;
9556 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9557 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9558 break;
9559
9560 default:
9561 return TRUE;
9562 }
9563
9564 return TRUE;
9565 }
9566
9567 static bfd_boolean
9568 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9569 {
9570 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9571
9572 switch (note->type)
9573 {
9574 default:
9575 return TRUE;
9576
9577 case NT_PRSTATUS:
9578 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
9579 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9580 return TRUE;
9581 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9582 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
9583 #else
9584 return TRUE;
9585 #endif
9586
9587 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9588 case NT_PSTATUS:
9589 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
9590 #endif
9591
9592 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9593 case NT_LWPSTATUS:
9594 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
9595 #endif
9596
9597 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
9598 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9599
9600 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
9601 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
9602
9603 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
9604 if (note->namesz == 6
9605 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9606 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
9607 else
9608 return TRUE;
9609
9610 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
9611 if (note->namesz == 6
9612 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9613 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9614 else
9615 return TRUE;
9616
9617 case NT_PPC_VMX:
9618 if (note->namesz == 6
9619 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9620 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
9621 else
9622 return TRUE;
9623
9624 case NT_PPC_VSX:
9625 if (note->namesz == 6
9626 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9627 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
9628 else
9629 return TRUE;
9630
9631 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
9632 if (note->namesz == 6
9633 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9634 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
9635 else
9636 return TRUE;
9637
9638 case NT_S390_TIMER:
9639 if (note->namesz == 6
9640 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9641 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
9642 else
9643 return TRUE;
9644
9645 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
9646 if (note->namesz == 6
9647 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9648 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
9649 else
9650 return TRUE;
9651
9652 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
9653 if (note->namesz == 6
9654 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9655 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
9656 else
9657 return TRUE;
9658
9659 case NT_S390_CTRS:
9660 if (note->namesz == 6
9661 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9662 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
9663 else
9664 return TRUE;
9665
9666 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
9667 if (note->namesz == 6
9668 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9669 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
9670 else
9671 return TRUE;
9672
9673 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
9674 if (note->namesz == 6
9675 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9676 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
9677 else
9678 return TRUE;
9679
9680 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
9681 if (note->namesz == 6
9682 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9683 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
9684 else
9685 return TRUE;
9686
9687 case NT_S390_TDB:
9688 if (note->namesz == 6
9689 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9690 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
9691 else
9692 return TRUE;
9693
9694 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
9695 if (note->namesz == 6
9696 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9697 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
9698 else
9699 return TRUE;
9700
9701 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
9702 if (note->namesz == 6
9703 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9704 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
9705 else
9706 return TRUE;
9707
9708 case NT_S390_GS_CB:
9709 if (note->namesz == 6
9710 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9711 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
9712 else
9713 return TRUE;
9714
9715 case NT_S390_GS_BC:
9716 if (note->namesz == 6
9717 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9718 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
9719 else
9720 return TRUE;
9721
9722 case NT_ARM_VFP:
9723 if (note->namesz == 6
9724 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9725 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
9726 else
9727 return TRUE;
9728
9729 case NT_ARM_TLS:
9730 if (note->namesz == 6
9731 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9732 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
9733 else
9734 return TRUE;
9735
9736 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
9737 if (note->namesz == 6
9738 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9739 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
9740 else
9741 return TRUE;
9742
9743 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
9744 if (note->namesz == 6
9745 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9746 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
9747 else
9748 return TRUE;
9749
9750 case NT_PRPSINFO:
9751 case NT_PSINFO:
9752 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
9753 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
9754 return TRUE;
9755 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9756 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
9757 #else
9758 return TRUE;
9759 #endif
9760
9761 case NT_AUXV:
9762 {
9763 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9764 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9765
9766 if (sect == NULL)
9767 return FALSE;
9768 sect->size = note->descsz;
9769 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9770 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9771
9772 return TRUE;
9773 }
9774
9775 case NT_FILE:
9776 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
9777 note);
9778
9779 case NT_SIGINFO:
9780 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
9781 note);
9782
9783 }
9784 }
9785
9786 static bfd_boolean
9787 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9788 {
9789 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
9790
9791 if (note->descsz == 0)
9792 return FALSE;
9793
9794 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
9795 if (build_id == NULL)
9796 return FALSE;
9797
9798 build_id->size = note->descsz;
9799 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9800 abfd->build_id = build_id;
9801
9802 return TRUE;
9803 }
9804
9805 static bfd_boolean
9806 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9807 {
9808 switch (note->type)
9809 {
9810 default:
9811 return TRUE;
9812
9813 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
9814 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
9815
9816 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
9817 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
9818 }
9819 }
9820
9821 static bfd_boolean
9822 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9823 {
9824 struct sdt_note *cur =
9825 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
9826 + note->descsz);
9827
9828 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
9829 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
9830 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9831
9832 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
9833
9834 return TRUE;
9835 }
9836
9837 static bfd_boolean
9838 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9839 {
9840 switch (note->type)
9841 {
9842 case NT_STAPSDT:
9843 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
9844
9845 default:
9846 return TRUE;
9847 }
9848 }
9849
9850 static bfd_boolean
9851 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9852 {
9853 size_t offset;
9854
9855 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
9856 {
9857 case ELFCLASS32:
9858 if (note->descsz < 108)
9859 return FALSE;
9860 break;
9861
9862 case ELFCLASS64:
9863 if (note->descsz < 120)
9864 return FALSE;
9865 break;
9866
9867 default:
9868 return FALSE;
9869 }
9870
9871 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
9872 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
9873 return FALSE;
9874
9875 offset = 4;
9876
9877 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
9878 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
9879 offset += 4;
9880 else
9881 {
9882 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
9883 offset += 8;
9884 }
9885
9886 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
9887 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9888 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
9889 offset += 17;
9890
9891 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
9892 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9893 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
9894 offset += 81;
9895
9896 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
9897 offset += 2;
9898
9899 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
9900 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
9901 return TRUE;
9902
9903 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
9904 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9905
9906 return TRUE;
9907 }
9908
9909 static bfd_boolean
9910 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9911 {
9912 size_t offset;
9913 size_t size;
9914 size_t min_size;
9915
9916 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
9917 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
9918 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
9919 {
9920 case ELFCLASS32:
9921 offset = 4 + 4;
9922 min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
9923 break;
9924
9925 case ELFCLASS64:
9926 offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
9927 min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
9928 break;
9929
9930 default:
9931 return FALSE;
9932 }
9933
9934 if (note->descsz < min_size)
9935 return FALSE;
9936
9937 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
9938 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
9939 return FALSE;
9940
9941 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
9942 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
9943 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
9944 {
9945 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9946 offset += 4 * 2;
9947 }
9948 else
9949 {
9950 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9951 offset += 8 * 2;
9952 }
9953
9954 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
9955 offset += 4;
9956
9957 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
9958 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9959 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
9960 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9961 offset += 4;
9962
9963 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
9964 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
9965 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9966 offset += 4;
9967
9968 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
9969 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
9970 offset += 4;
9971
9972 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
9973 if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
9974 return FALSE;
9975
9976 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9977 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9978 size, note->descpos + offset);
9979 }
9980
9981 static bfd_boolean
9982 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9983 {
9984 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9985
9986 switch (note->type)
9987 {
9988 case NT_PRSTATUS:
9989 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
9990 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9991 return TRUE;
9992 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
9993
9994 case NT_FPREGSET:
9995 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9996
9997 case NT_PRPSINFO:
9998 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
9999
10000 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10001 if (note->namesz == 8)
10002 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10003 else
10004 return TRUE;
10005
10006 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10007 {
10008 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10009 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10010
10011 if (sect == NULL)
10012 return FALSE;
10013 sect->size = note->descsz - 4;
10014 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 4;
10015 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10016
10017 return TRUE;
10018 }
10019
10020 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10021 if (note->namesz == 8)
10022 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10023 else
10024 return TRUE;
10025
10026 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10027 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10028 note);
10029
10030 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10031 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10032
10033 default:
10034 return TRUE;
10035 }
10036 }
10037
10038 static bfd_boolean
10039 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10040 {
10041 char *cp;
10042
10043 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10044 if (cp != NULL)
10045 {
10046 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10047 return TRUE;
10048 }
10049 return FALSE;
10050 }
10051
10052 static bfd_boolean
10053 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10054 {
10055 if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10056 return FALSE;
10057
10058 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10059 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10060 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10061
10062 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10063 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10064 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10065
10066 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10067 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10068 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10069
10070 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10071 note);
10072 }
10073
10074 static bfd_boolean
10075 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10076 {
10077 int lwp;
10078
10079 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10080 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10081
10082 if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
10083 {
10084 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10085 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10086 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10087 creates a core file. */
10088
10089 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10090 }
10091
10092 /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
10093 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10094 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10095 understand it. */
10096
10097 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10098 return TRUE;
10099
10100
10101 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10102 {
10103 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10104 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10105
10106 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10107 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10108 switch (note->type)
10109 {
10110 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10111 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10112
10113 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10114 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10115
10116 default:
10117 return TRUE;
10118 }
10119
10120 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10121 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10122
10123 default:
10124 switch (note->type)
10125 {
10126 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
10127 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10128
10129 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10130 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10131
10132 default:
10133 return TRUE;
10134 }
10135 }
10136 /* NOTREACHED */
10137 }
10138
10139 static bfd_boolean
10140 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10141 {
10142 if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
10143 return FALSE;
10144
10145 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10146 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10147 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10148
10149 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10150 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10151 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
10152
10153 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10154 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10155 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
10156
10157 return TRUE;
10158 }
10159
10160 static bfd_boolean
10161 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10162 {
10163 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
10164 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10165
10166 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
10167 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10168
10169 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
10170 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10171
10172 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
10173 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
10174
10175 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
10176 {
10177 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10178 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10179
10180 if (sect == NULL)
10181 return FALSE;
10182 sect->size = note->descsz;
10183 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10184 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10185
10186 return TRUE;
10187 }
10188
10189 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
10190 {
10191 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
10192 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10193
10194 if (sect == NULL)
10195 return FALSE;
10196 sect->size = note->descsz;
10197 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10198 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10199
10200 return TRUE;
10201 }
10202
10203 return TRUE;
10204 }
10205
10206 static bfd_boolean
10207 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
10208 {
10209 void *ddata = note->descdata;
10210 char buf[100];
10211 char *name;
10212 asection *sect;
10213 short sig;
10214 unsigned flags;
10215
10216 if (note->descsz < 16)
10217 return FALSE;
10218
10219 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
10220 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
10221
10222 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
10223 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
10224
10225 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
10226 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
10227
10228 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
10229 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
10230 {
10231 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
10232 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10233 }
10234
10235 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
10236 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
10237 thread just in case. */
10238 if (flags & 0x00000080)
10239 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10240
10241 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
10242 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
10243
10244 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10245 if (name == NULL)
10246 return FALSE;
10247 strcpy (name, buf);
10248
10249 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10250 if (sect == NULL)
10251 return FALSE;
10252
10253 sect->size = note->descsz;
10254 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10255 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10256
10257 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
10258 }
10259
10260 static bfd_boolean
10261 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
10262 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
10263 long tid,
10264 char *base)
10265 {
10266 char buf[100];
10267 char *name;
10268 asection *sect;
10269
10270 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
10271 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
10272
10273 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10274 if (name == NULL)
10275 return FALSE;
10276 strcpy (name, buf);
10277
10278 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10279 if (sect == NULL)
10280 return FALSE;
10281
10282 sect->size = note->descsz;
10283 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10284 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10285
10286 /* This is the current thread. */
10287 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
10288 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
10289
10290 return TRUE;
10291 }
10292
10293 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
10294 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
10295 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
10296 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
10297
10298 static bfd_boolean
10299 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10300 {
10301 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
10302 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
10303 function. */
10304 static long tid = 1;
10305
10306 switch (note->type)
10307 {
10308 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
10309 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
10310 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
10311 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
10312 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
10313 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
10314 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
10315 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
10316 default:
10317 return TRUE;
10318 }
10319 }
10320
10321 static bfd_boolean
10322 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10323 {
10324 char *name;
10325 asection *sect;
10326 size_t len;
10327
10328 /* Use note name as section name. */
10329 len = note->namesz;
10330 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10331 if (name == NULL)
10332 return FALSE;
10333 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
10334 name[len - 1] = '\0';
10335
10336 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10337 if (sect == NULL)
10338 return FALSE;
10339
10340 sect->size = note->descsz;
10341 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10342 sect->alignment_power = 1;
10343
10344 return TRUE;
10345 }
10346
10347 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
10348
10349 Inputs:
10350 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
10351 name of note
10352 type of note
10353 data for note
10354 size of data for note
10355
10356 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
10357 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
10358 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
10359 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
10360
10361 Return:
10362 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
10363
10364 char *
10365 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
10366 char *buf,
10367 int *bufsiz,
10368 const char *name,
10369 int type,
10370 const void *input,
10371 int size)
10372 {
10373 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
10374 size_t namesz;
10375 size_t newspace;
10376 char *dest;
10377
10378 namesz = 0;
10379 if (name != NULL)
10380 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
10381
10382 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
10383
10384 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
10385 if (buf == NULL)
10386 return buf;
10387 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
10388 *bufsiz += newspace;
10389 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
10390 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
10391 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
10392 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
10393 dest = xnp->name;
10394 if (name != NULL)
10395 {
10396 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
10397 dest += namesz;
10398 while (namesz & 3)
10399 {
10400 *dest++ = '\0';
10401 ++namesz;
10402 }
10403 }
10404 memcpy (dest, input, size);
10405 dest += size;
10406 while (size & 3)
10407 {
10408 *dest++ = '\0';
10409 ++size;
10410 }
10411 return buf;
10412 }
10413
10414 char *
10415 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
10416 char *buf,
10417 int *bufsiz,
10418 const char *fname,
10419 const char *psargs)
10420 {
10421 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10422
10423 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10424 {
10425 char *ret;
10426 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10427 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
10428 if (ret != NULL)
10429 return ret;
10430 }
10431
10432 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10433 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10434 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10435 {
10436 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10437 psinfo32_t data;
10438 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10439 #else
10440 prpsinfo32_t data;
10441 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10442 #endif
10443
10444 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10445 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10446 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10447 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10448 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10449 }
10450 else
10451 #endif
10452 {
10453 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10454 psinfo_t data;
10455 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10456 #else
10457 prpsinfo_t data;
10458 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10459 #endif
10460
10461 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10462 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10463 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10464 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10465 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10466 }
10467 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
10468
10469 free (buf);
10470 return NULL;
10471 }
10472
10473 char *
10474 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
10475 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10476 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10477 {
10478 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
10479 {
10480 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
10481
10482 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10483 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10484 &data, sizeof (data));
10485 }
10486 else
10487 {
10488 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
10489
10490 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10491 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10492 &data, sizeof (data));
10493 }
10494 }
10495
10496 char *
10497 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
10498 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10499 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10500 {
10501 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
10502 {
10503 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
10504
10505 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10506 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10507 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10508 }
10509 else
10510 {
10511 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
10512
10513 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10514 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10515 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10516 }
10517 }
10518
10519 char *
10520 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
10521 char *buf,
10522 int *bufsiz,
10523 long pid,
10524 int cursig,
10525 const void *gregs)
10526 {
10527 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10528
10529 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10530 {
10531 char *ret;
10532 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10533 NT_PRSTATUS,
10534 pid, cursig, gregs);
10535 if (ret != NULL)
10536 return ret;
10537 }
10538
10539 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10540 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
10541 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10542 {
10543 prstatus32_t prstat;
10544
10545 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10546 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10547 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10548 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10549 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10550 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10551 }
10552 else
10553 #endif
10554 {
10555 prstatus_t prstat;
10556
10557 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10558 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10559 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10560 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10561 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10562 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10563 }
10564 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
10565
10566 free (buf);
10567 return NULL;
10568 }
10569
10570 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10571 char *
10572 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
10573 char *buf,
10574 int *bufsiz,
10575 long pid,
10576 int cursig,
10577 const void *gregs)
10578 {
10579 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10580 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10581
10582 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
10583 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
10584 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10585 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10586 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
10587 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10588 #if !defined(gregs)
10589 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
10590 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
10591 #else
10592 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
10593 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
10594 #endif
10595 #endif
10596 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10597 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
10598 }
10599 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
10600
10601 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10602 char *
10603 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
10604 char *buf,
10605 int *bufsiz,
10606 long pid,
10607 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10608 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10609 {
10610 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10611 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10612 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10613
10614 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10615 {
10616 pstatus32_t pstat;
10617
10618 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10619 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10620 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10621 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10622 return buf;
10623 }
10624 else
10625 #endif
10626 {
10627 pstatus_t pstat;
10628
10629 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10630 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10631 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10632 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10633 return buf;
10634 }
10635 }
10636 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
10637
10638 char *
10639 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10640 char *buf,
10641 int *bufsiz,
10642 const void *fpregs,
10643 int size)
10644 {
10645 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10646 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10647 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
10648 }
10649
10650 char *
10651 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10652 char *buf,
10653 int *bufsiz,
10654 const void *xfpregs,
10655 int size)
10656 {
10657 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10658 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10659 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
10660 }
10661
10662 char *
10663 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10664 const void *xfpregs, int size)
10665 {
10666 char *note_name;
10667 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
10668 note_name = "FreeBSD";
10669 else
10670 note_name = "LINUX";
10671 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10672 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
10673 }
10674
10675 char *
10676 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
10677 char *buf,
10678 int *bufsiz,
10679 const void *ppc_vmx,
10680 int size)
10681 {
10682 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10683 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10684 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
10685 }
10686
10687 char *
10688 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
10689 char *buf,
10690 int *bufsiz,
10691 const void *ppc_vsx,
10692 int size)
10693 {
10694 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10695 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10696 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
10697 }
10698
10699 static char *
10700 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
10701 char *buf,
10702 int *bufsiz,
10703 const void *s390_high_gprs,
10704 int size)
10705 {
10706 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10707 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10708 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
10709 s390_high_gprs, size);
10710 }
10711
10712 char *
10713 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
10714 char *buf,
10715 int *bufsiz,
10716 const void *s390_timer,
10717 int size)
10718 {
10719 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10720 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10721 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
10722 }
10723
10724 char *
10725 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
10726 char *buf,
10727 int *bufsiz,
10728 const void *s390_todcmp,
10729 int size)
10730 {
10731 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10732 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10733 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
10734 }
10735
10736 char *
10737 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
10738 char *buf,
10739 int *bufsiz,
10740 const void *s390_todpreg,
10741 int size)
10742 {
10743 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10744 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10745 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
10746 }
10747
10748 char *
10749 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
10750 char *buf,
10751 int *bufsiz,
10752 const void *s390_ctrs,
10753 int size)
10754 {
10755 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10756 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10757 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
10758 }
10759
10760 char *
10761 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
10762 char *buf,
10763 int *bufsiz,
10764 const void *s390_prefix,
10765 int size)
10766 {
10767 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10768 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10769 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
10770 }
10771
10772 char *
10773 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
10774 char *buf,
10775 int *bufsiz,
10776 const void *s390_last_break,
10777 int size)
10778 {
10779 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10780 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10781 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
10782 s390_last_break, size);
10783 }
10784
10785 char *
10786 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
10787 char *buf,
10788 int *bufsiz,
10789 const void *s390_system_call,
10790 int size)
10791 {
10792 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10793 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10794 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
10795 s390_system_call, size);
10796 }
10797
10798 char *
10799 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
10800 char *buf,
10801 int *bufsiz,
10802 const void *s390_tdb,
10803 int size)
10804 {
10805 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10806 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10807 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
10808 }
10809
10810 char *
10811 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
10812 char *buf,
10813 int *bufsiz,
10814 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
10815 int size)
10816 {
10817 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10818 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10819 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
10820 }
10821
10822 char *
10823 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
10824 char *buf,
10825 int *bufsiz,
10826 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
10827 int size)
10828 {
10829 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10830 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10831 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
10832 s390_vxrs_high, size);
10833 }
10834
10835 char *
10836 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
10837 char *buf,
10838 int *bufsiz,
10839 const void *s390_gs_cb,
10840 int size)
10841 {
10842 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10843 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10844 note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
10845 s390_gs_cb, size);
10846 }
10847
10848 char *
10849 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
10850 char *buf,
10851 int *bufsiz,
10852 const void *s390_gs_bc,
10853 int size)
10854 {
10855 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10856 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10857 note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
10858 s390_gs_bc, size);
10859 }
10860
10861 char *
10862 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
10863 char *buf,
10864 int *bufsiz,
10865 const void *arm_vfp,
10866 int size)
10867 {
10868 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10869 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10870 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
10871 }
10872
10873 char *
10874 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
10875 char *buf,
10876 int *bufsiz,
10877 const void *aarch_tls,
10878 int size)
10879 {
10880 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10881 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10882 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
10883 }
10884
10885 char *
10886 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
10887 char *buf,
10888 int *bufsiz,
10889 const void *aarch_hw_break,
10890 int size)
10891 {
10892 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10893 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10894 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
10895 }
10896
10897 char *
10898 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
10899 char *buf,
10900 int *bufsiz,
10901 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
10902 int size)
10903 {
10904 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10905 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10906 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
10907 }
10908
10909 char *
10910 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
10911 char *buf,
10912 int *bufsiz,
10913 const char *section,
10914 const void *data,
10915 int size)
10916 {
10917 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
10918 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10919 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
10920 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10921 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
10922 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10923 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
10924 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10925 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
10926 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10927 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
10928 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10929 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
10930 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10931 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
10932 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10933 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
10934 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10935 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
10936 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10937 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
10938 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10939 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
10940 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10941 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
10942 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10943 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
10944 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10945 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
10946 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10947 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
10948 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10949 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
10950 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10951 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
10952 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10953 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
10954 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10955 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
10956 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10957 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
10958 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10959 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
10960 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10961 return NULL;
10962 }
10963
10964 static bfd_boolean
10965 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset)
10966 {
10967 char *p;
10968
10969 p = buf;
10970 while (p < buf + size)
10971 {
10972 /* FIXME: bad alignment assumption. */
10973 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
10974 Elf_Internal_Note in;
10975
10976 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
10977 return FALSE;
10978
10979 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
10980
10981 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
10982 in.namedata = xnp->name;
10983 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
10984 return FALSE;
10985
10986 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
10987 in.descdata = in.namedata + BFD_ALIGN (in.namesz, 4);
10988 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
10989 if (in.descsz != 0
10990 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
10991 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
10992 return FALSE;
10993
10994 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
10995 {
10996 default:
10997 return TRUE;
10998
10999 case bfd_core:
11000 {
11001 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
11002 struct
11003 {
11004 const char * string;
11005 size_t len;
11006 bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
11007 }
11008 grokers[] =
11009 {
11010 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
11011 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
11012 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
11013 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
11014 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
11015 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
11016 };
11017 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
11018 int i;
11019
11020 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
11021 {
11022 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
11023 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
11024 grokers[i].len) == 0)
11025 {
11026 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
11027 return FALSE;
11028 break;
11029 }
11030 }
11031 break;
11032 }
11033
11034 case bfd_object:
11035 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
11036 {
11037 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
11038 return FALSE;
11039 }
11040 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
11041 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
11042 {
11043 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
11044 return FALSE;
11045 }
11046 break;
11047 }
11048
11049 p = in.descdata + BFD_ALIGN (in.descsz, 4);
11050 }
11051
11052 return TRUE;
11053 }
11054
11055 static bfd_boolean
11056 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size)
11057 {
11058 char *buf;
11059
11060 if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
11061 return TRUE;
11062
11063 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
11064 return FALSE;
11065
11066 buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
11067 if (buf == NULL)
11068 return FALSE;
11069
11070 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
11071 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
11072 buf[size] = 0;
11073
11074 if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
11075 || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset))
11076 {
11077 free (buf);
11078 return FALSE;
11079 }
11080
11081 free (buf);
11082 return TRUE;
11083 }
11084 \f
11085 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
11086
11087 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
11088 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
11089 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11090
11091 long
11092 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
11093 {
11094 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11095 {
11096 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11097 return -1;
11098 }
11099
11100 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
11101 }
11102
11103 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
11104 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
11105 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
11106 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
11107
11108 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
11109 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11110
11111 int
11112 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
11113 {
11114 int num_phdrs;
11115
11116 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11117 {
11118 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11119 return -1;
11120 }
11121
11122 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
11123 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
11124 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
11125
11126 return num_phdrs;
11127 }
11128
11129 enum elf_reloc_type_class
11130 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11131 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11132 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11133 {
11134 return reloc_class_normal;
11135 }
11136
11137 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
11138 relocation against a local symbol. */
11139
11140 bfd_vma
11141 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11142 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11143 asection **psec,
11144 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
11145 {
11146 asection *sec = *psec;
11147 bfd_vma relocation;
11148
11149 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
11150 + sec->output_offset
11151 + sym->st_value);
11152 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
11153 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
11154 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11155 {
11156 rel->r_addend =
11157 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11158 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11159 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
11160 if (sec != *psec)
11161 {
11162 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
11163 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
11164 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
11165 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
11166 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
11167 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
11168 sec->kept_section = *psec;
11169 sec = *psec;
11170 }
11171 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
11172 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
11173 }
11174 return relocation;
11175 }
11176
11177 bfd_vma
11178 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11179 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11180 asection **psec,
11181 bfd_vma addend)
11182 {
11183 asection *sec = *psec;
11184
11185 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11186 return sym->st_value + addend;
11187
11188 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11189 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11190 sym->st_value + addend);
11191 }
11192
11193 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
11194 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
11195 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
11196 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
11197 byte may be. */
11198
11199 bfd_vma
11200 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
11201 struct bfd_link_info *info,
11202 asection *sec,
11203 bfd_vma offset)
11204 {
11205 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
11206 {
11207 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
11208 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11209 offset);
11210 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
11211 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
11212
11213 default:
11214 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
11215 {
11216 /* Reverse the offset. */
11217 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11218 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
11219
11220 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
11221 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
11222 offset = (sec->size - address_size) / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd) - offset;
11223 }
11224 return offset;
11225 }
11226 }
11227 \f
11228 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
11229 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
11230 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
11231 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
11232 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
11233 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
11234
11235 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
11236 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
11237 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
11238 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
11239 the remote memory. */
11240
11241 bfd *
11242 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
11243 (bfd *templ,
11244 bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
11245 bfd_size_type size,
11246 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
11247 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
11248 {
11249 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
11250 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
11251 }
11252 \f
11253 long
11254 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
11255 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11256 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11257 long dynsymcount,
11258 asymbol **dynsyms,
11259 asymbol **ret)
11260 {
11261 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11262 asection *relplt;
11263 asymbol *s;
11264 const char *relplt_name;
11265 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
11266 arelent *p;
11267 long count, i, n;
11268 size_t size;
11269 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
11270 char *names;
11271 asection *plt;
11272
11273 *ret = NULL;
11274
11275 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
11276 return 0;
11277
11278 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
11279 return 0;
11280
11281 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
11282 return 0;
11283
11284 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
11285 if (relplt_name == NULL)
11286 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
11287 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
11288 if (relplt == NULL)
11289 return 0;
11290
11291 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
11292 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
11293 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
11294 return 0;
11295
11296 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
11297 if (plt == NULL)
11298 return 0;
11299
11300 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
11301 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
11302 return -1;
11303
11304 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
11305 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
11306 p = relplt->relocation;
11307 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11308 {
11309 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
11310 if (p->addend != 0)
11311 {
11312 #ifdef BFD64
11313 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
11314 #else
11315 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
11316 #endif
11317 }
11318 }
11319
11320 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
11321 if (s == NULL)
11322 return -1;
11323
11324 names = (char *) (s + count);
11325 p = relplt->relocation;
11326 n = 0;
11327 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11328 {
11329 size_t len;
11330 bfd_vma addr;
11331
11332 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
11333 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
11334 continue;
11335
11336 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
11337 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
11338 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
11339 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
11340 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
11341 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
11342 s->section = plt;
11343 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
11344 s->name = names;
11345 s->udata.p = NULL;
11346 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
11347 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
11348 names += len;
11349 if (p->addend != 0)
11350 {
11351 char buf[30], *a;
11352
11353 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
11354 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
11355 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
11356 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
11357 ;
11358 len = strlen (a);
11359 memcpy (names, a, len);
11360 names += len;
11361 }
11362 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
11363 names += sizeof ("@plt");
11364 ++s, ++n;
11365 }
11366
11367 return n;
11368 }
11369
11370 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
11371 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
11372 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
11373 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
11374 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
11375 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
11376 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
11377 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
11378
11379 void
11380 _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
11381 struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11382 {
11383 Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
11384
11385 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
11386
11387 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
11388
11389 /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
11390 osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
11391 the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
11392 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
11393 && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
11394 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
11395 }
11396
11397
11398 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
11399 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
11400 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
11401
11402 bfd_boolean
11403 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
11404 {
11405 return (type == STT_FUNC
11406 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
11407 }
11408
11409 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
11410 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
11411 otherwise return zero. */
11412
11413 bfd_size_type
11414 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
11415 bfd_vma *code_off)
11416 {
11417 bfd_size_type size;
11418
11419 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
11420 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
11421 || sym->section != sec)
11422 return 0;
11423
11424 *code_off = sym->value;
11425 size = 0;
11426 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
11427 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
11428 if (size == 0)
11429 size = 1;
11430 return size;
11431 }
This page took 0.316657 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.